blob: 51b3428f090b2a06fe93fdc4fa5e2823c00b1693 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau60612eb2011-09-10 23:43:11 +02007 2011/09/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100788.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200798.3. Advanced logging options
808.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
818.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
828.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
838.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
848.4. Timing events
858.5. Session state at disconnection
868.6. Non-printable characters
878.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
888.8. Capturing HTTP headers
898.9. Examples of logs
90
919. Statistics and monitoring
929.1. CSV format
939.2. Unix Socket commands
94
95
961. Quick reminder about HTTP
97----------------------------
98
99When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
100fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
101on almost anything found in the contents.
102
103However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
104formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
105correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
106
107
1081.1. The HTTP transaction model
109-------------------------------
110
111The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100112to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
114connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
115will involve a new connection :
116
117 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
118
119In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
120establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
121by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
122length.
123
124Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
125to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
126however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
127response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
128header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
129
130 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
131
132Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
133power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
134but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200135a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
137A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
138keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
139second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
140page :
141
142 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
143
144This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
145latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
146correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
147the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100148server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200150By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
151connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
152everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
153established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
154sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
155while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
156another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
157sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
158http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
159mode.
160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161
1621.2. HTTP request
163-----------------
164
165First, let's consider this HTTP request :
166
167 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100168 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
170 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
171 3 User-agent: my small browser
172 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
173 5 Accept: image/png
174
175
1761.2.1. The Request line
177-----------------------
178
179Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
180
181 - a METHOD : GET
182 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
183 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
184
185All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
186which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
187followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
188is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
189desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
190the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
191
192The URI itself can have several forms :
193
194 - A "relative URI" :
195
196 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
197
198 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
199 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
200
201 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
202
203 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
204
205 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
206 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
207 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
208 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
209 must accept this form too.
210
211 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
212 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
213 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100214
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
216 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
217 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
218 other protocols too.
219
220In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
221mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
222on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
223It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
224specific to the language, framework or application in use.
225
226
2271.2.2. The request headers
228--------------------------
229
230The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
231beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
232an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
233Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
234values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
235encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
236the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
237define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
238
239Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
240their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
241"Connection:" header).
242
243The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
244that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
245is one valid form of empty line.
246
247Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
248headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
249about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
250application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
251
252Important note:
253 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
254 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
255 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
256 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
257
258
2591.3. HTTP response
260------------------
261
262An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
263messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
264
265 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100266 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200267 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
268 2 Content-length: 350
269 3 Content-Type: text/html
270
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200271As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
272codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
273response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100274continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
275the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
276following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
277sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
278(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
279correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
280such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
281state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
282over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
283if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
284information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200286
2871.3.1. The Response line
288------------------------
289
290Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
291
292 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
293 - a status code : 200
294 - a reason : OK
295
296The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200297 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
299 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
300 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
301 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
302
303Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100304"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200305found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
306messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
307or "Authentication Required".
308
309Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
310
311 Code When / reason
312 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
313 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
316 400 for an invalid or too large request
317 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
318 accessing the stats page)
319 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
320 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
321 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
322 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
323 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
324 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
325 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
326 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
327 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
328
329The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3304.2).
331
332
3331.3.2. The response headers
334---------------------------
335
336Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
337the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
338details.
339
340
3412. Configuring HAProxy
342----------------------
343
3442.1. Configuration file format
345------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200346
347HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
348
349 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
350 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
351 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
352 "frontend" and "backend".
353
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100354The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
355referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
356delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100357preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100358escaped by doubling them.
359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
3612.2. Time format
362----------------
363
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100364Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100365values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
366otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
367numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
368for every keyword. Supported units are :
369
370 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
371 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
372 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
373 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
374 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
375 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
376
377
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003782.3. Examples
379-------------
380
381 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
382 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
383 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
384 global
385 daemon
386 maxconn 256
387
388 defaults
389 mode http
390 timeout connect 5000ms
391 timeout client 50000ms
392 timeout server 50000ms
393
394 frontend http-in
395 bind *:80
396 default_backend servers
397
398 backend servers
399 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
400
401
402 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
403 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
404 global
405 daemon
406 maxconn 256
407
408 defaults
409 mode http
410 timeout connect 5000ms
411 timeout client 50000ms
412 timeout server 50000ms
413
414 listen http-in
415 bind *:80
416 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
417
418
419Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
420
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100421 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200422
423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004243. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200425--------------------
426
427Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
428are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
429of them have command-line equivalents.
430
431The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
432
433 * Process management and security
434 - chroot
435 - daemon
436 - gid
437 - group
438 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100439 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200440 - nbproc
441 - pidfile
442 - uid
443 - ulimit-n
444 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200445 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200446 - node
447 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100448 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100449
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 * Performance tuning
451 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200452 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100453 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200454 - noepoll
455 - nokqueue
456 - nopoll
457 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100458 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200459 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200460 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200461 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200462 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100463 - tune.maxaccept
464 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200465 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200466 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100467 - tune.rcvbuf.client
468 - tune.rcvbuf.server
469 - tune.sndbuf.client
470 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100471
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200472 * Debugging
473 - debug
474 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200475
476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004773.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200478------------------------------------
479
480chroot <jail dir>
481 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
482 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
483 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
484 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
485 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
486 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100487
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200488daemon
489 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
490 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
491 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
492
493gid <number>
494 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
495 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
496 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
497 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100498
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499group <group name>
500 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
501 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100502
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200503log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
505 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100506 configured with "log global".
507
508 <address> can be one of:
509
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100510 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100511 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
512 port).
513
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100514 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
515 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
516 port).
517
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100518 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
519 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
520 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
521 writeable).
522
523 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200524
525 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
526 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
527 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
528
529 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200530 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
531 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
532 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
533 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
534 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
535 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536
537 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
538
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100539log-send-hostname [<string>]
540 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
541 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
542 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
543 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
544 the logs.
545
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000546log-tag <string>
547 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
548 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
549 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
550 running on the same host.
551
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552nbproc <number>
553 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
554 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
555 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
556 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
557 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
558
559pidfile <pidfile>
560 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
561 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
562 starting the process. See also "daemon".
563
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200564stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200565 [level <level>]
566
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200567 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
568 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100569 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200570 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
571
572 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
573 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
574 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
575 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
576 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
577
578 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200579 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200580 counters).
581
582 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
583 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100584
585 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
586 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
587 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
588 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
589 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
590 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
591 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200592
593stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
594 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
595 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100596 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200597
598stats maxconn <connections>
599 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
600 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
601
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200602uid <number>
603 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
604 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
605 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
606 one. See also "gid" and "user".
607
608ulimit-n <number>
609 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
610 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
611 option.
612
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100613unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
614 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
615
616 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
617 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
618 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
619 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
620 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
621 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
622 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
623 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
624 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
625 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
626
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627user <user name>
628 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
629 See also "uid" and "group".
630
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200631node <name>
632 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
633
634 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
635 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
636 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
637 traffic.
638
639description <text>
640 Add a text that describes the instance.
641
642 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
643 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
644 "<" and ">" characters.
645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006473.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648-----------------------
649
650maxconn <number>
651 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
652 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
653 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
654 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
655
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200656maxconnrate <number>
657 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
658 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
659 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
660 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
661 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
662 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
663 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
664 fairness.
665
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100666maxpipes <number>
667 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
668 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
669 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
670 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
671 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
672 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
673
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674noepoll
675 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
676 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
677 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
678
679nokqueue
680 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
681 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
682 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
683
684nopoll
685 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
686 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100687 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200688 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
689 "nokqueue".
690
691nosepoll
692 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
693 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
694 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
695
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100696nosplice
697 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
698 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
699 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100700 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100701 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
702 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
703 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
704 "option splice-response".
705
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200706spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
707 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
708 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
709 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
710 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
711 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
712
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200713tune.bufsize <number>
714 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
715 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
716 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
717 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
718 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
719 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
720 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
721 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
722
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200723tune.chksize <number>
724 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
725 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
726 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
727 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
728 checks whenever possible.
729
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200730tune.http.maxhdr <number>
731 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
732 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
733 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
734 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
735 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
736 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
737 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
738 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
739 limit too high.
740
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100741tune.maxaccept <number>
742 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
743 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
744 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100745 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100746 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
747 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100748 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100749 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
750
751tune.maxpollevents <number>
752 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
753 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
754 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
755 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
756 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
757
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200758tune.maxrewrite <number>
759 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
760 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
761 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
762 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
763 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
764 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
765 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
766 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
767 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
768 bufsize.
769
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200770tune.pipesize <number>
771 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
772 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
773 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
774 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
775 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
776 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
777
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100778tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
779tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
780 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
781 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
782 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
783 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
784 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
785 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
786 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
787
788tune.sndbuf.client <number>
789tune.sndbuf.server <number>
790 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
791 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
792 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
793 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
794 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
795 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
796 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
797 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
798 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
799 notifying haproxy again.
800
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008023.3. Debugging
803--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804
805debug
806 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
807 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
808 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
809 system startup.
810
811quiet
812 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
813 line argument "-q".
814
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008163.4. Userlists
817--------------
818It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
819http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
820it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
821
822userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100823 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100824 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
825
826group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100827 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100828 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
829 proceeded by "users" keyword.
830
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100831user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
832 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100833 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
834 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100835 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
836 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100837 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
838 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
839
840
841 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100842 userlist L1
843 group G1 users tiger,scott
844 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100845
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100846 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
847 user scott insecure-password elgato
848 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100849
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100850 userlist L2
851 group G1
852 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100853
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100854 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
855 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
856 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100857
858 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200859
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200860
8613.5. Peers
862--------------
863It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
864haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
865pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
866identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
867or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
868Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
869known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
870the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
871process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
872during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
873tables.
874
875peers <peersect>
876 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
877 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
878
879peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
880 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
881 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
882 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
883 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
884 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
885 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
886
887 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
888 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
889
890 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
891 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
892 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
893 across all peers.
894
895Example:
896 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100897 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
898 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
899 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200900
901 backend mybackend
902 mode tcp
903 balance roundrobin
904 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
905 stick on src
906
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100907 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
908 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200909
910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009114. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200912----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100913
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200914Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
915 - defaults <name>
916 - frontend <name>
917 - backend <name>
918 - listen <name>
919
920A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
921its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
922section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100923section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200924
925A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
926connections.
927
928A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
929to forward incoming connections.
930
931A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
932parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
933
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100934All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
935'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
936case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
937
938Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
939logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
940proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
941However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
942name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
943
944Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
945and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100946bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100947protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
948modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
949arbitrary criteria.
950
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100951
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
953--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200955The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
956limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
957they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
958limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100959marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200960option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200961and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
962with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
963specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100964
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100966 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
967------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
968acl - X X X
969appsession - - X X
970backlog X X X -
971balance X - X X
972bind - X X -
973bind-process X X X X
974block - X X X
975capture cookie - X X -
976capture request header - X X -
977capture response header - X X -
978clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
979contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
980cookie X - X X
981default-server X - X X
982default_backend X X X -
983description - X X X
984disabled X X X X
985dispatch - - X X
986enabled X X X X
987errorfile X X X X
988errorloc X X X X
989errorloc302 X X X X
990-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
991errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200992force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100993fullconn X - X X
994grace X X X X
995hash-type X - X X
996http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100997http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200998http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100999http-request - X X X
1000id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001001ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001002log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001003maxconn X X X -
1004mode X X X X
1005monitor fail - X X -
1006monitor-net X X X -
1007monitor-uri X X X -
1008option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1009option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1010option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1011option allbackups (*) X - X X
1012option checkcache (*) X - X X
1013option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1014option contstats (*) X X X -
1015option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1016option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1017option forceclose (*) X X X X
1018-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1019option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001020option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001021option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001022option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1023option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1024option httpchk X - X X
1025option httpclose (*) X X X X
1026option httplog X X X X
1027option http_proxy (*) X X X X
1028option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001029option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001030option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1031option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1032option logasap (*) X X X -
1033option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001034option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001035option nolinger (*) X X X X
1036option originalto X X X X
1037option persist (*) X - X X
1038option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001039option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001040option smtpchk X - X X
1041option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1042option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1043option splice-request (*) X X X X
1044option splice-response (*) X X X X
1045option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1046option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1047-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1048option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1049option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1050option tcpka X X X X
1051option tcplog X X X X
1052option transparent (*) X - X X
1053persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1054rate-limit sessions X X X -
1055redirect - X X X
1056redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1057redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1058reqadd - X X X
1059reqallow - X X X
1060reqdel - X X X
1061reqdeny - X X X
1062reqiallow - X X X
1063reqidel - X X X
1064reqideny - X X X
1065reqipass - X X X
1066reqirep - X X X
1067reqisetbe - X X X
1068reqitarpit - X X X
1069reqpass - X X X
1070reqrep - X X X
1071-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1072reqsetbe - X X X
1073reqtarpit - X X X
1074retries X - X X
1075rspadd - X X X
1076rspdel - X X X
1077rspdeny - X X X
1078rspidel - X X X
1079rspideny - X X X
1080rspirep - X X X
1081rsprep - X X X
1082server - - X X
1083source X - X X
1084srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001085stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001086stats auth X - X X
1087stats enable X - X X
1088stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001089stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001090stats realm X - X X
1091stats refresh X - X X
1092stats scope X - X X
1093stats show-desc X - X X
1094stats show-legends X - X X
1095stats show-node X - X X
1096stats uri X - X X
1097-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1098stick match - - X X
1099stick on - - X X
1100stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001101stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001102stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001103tcp-request connection - X X -
1104tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001105tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001106tcp-response content - - X X
1107tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001108timeout check X - X X
1109timeout client X X X -
1110timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1111timeout connect X - X X
1112timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1113timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1114timeout http-request X X X X
1115timeout queue X - X X
1116timeout server X - X X
1117timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1118timeout tarpit X X X X
1119transparent (deprecated) X - X X
1120use_backend - X X -
1121------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1122 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001123
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011254.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1126---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001127
1128This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1129
1130
1131acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1132 Declare or complete an access list.
1133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1134 no | yes | yes | yes
1135 Example:
1136 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1137 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1138 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001140 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001141
1142
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001143appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1144 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001145 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1147 no | no | yes | yes
1148 Arguments :
1149 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1150 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1151
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001152 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001153 checked in each cookie value.
1154
1155 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1156 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1157 milliseconds.
1158
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001159 request-learn
1160 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1161 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1162 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1163 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1164 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1165 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1166
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001167 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1168 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1169 data following this prefix.
1170
1171 Example :
1172 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1173
1174 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1175 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1176
1177 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1178 2 modes are currently supported :
1179 - path-parameters :
1180 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1181 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1182 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1183 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1184 - query-string :
1185 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1186 query string.
1187
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001188 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1189 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1190 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1191 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001192 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1193 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1194 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001195 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1196 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1197
1198 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1199
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001200 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1201 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1202 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1203
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001204 Example :
1205 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1206
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001207 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1208 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001209
1210
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001211backlog <conns>
1212 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1214 yes | yes | yes | no
1215 Arguments :
1216 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1217 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1218 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1219
1220 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1221 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1222 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1223 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1224 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1225 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1226 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1227 backlog parameter.
1228
1229 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1230 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1231 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1232
1233 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1234
1235
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001236balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001237balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001238 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1240 yes | no | yes | yes
1241 Arguments :
1242 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1243 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1244 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1245 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1246
1247 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1248 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1249 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1250 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001251 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1252 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1253 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1254 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1255 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1256 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1257 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1258 it, so that you don't worry.
1259
1260 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1261 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1262 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1263 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1264 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1265 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1266 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1267 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001268
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001269 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1270 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1271 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1272 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1273 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1274 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1275 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1276 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1277
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001278 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1279 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1280 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1281 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1282 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1283 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1284 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1285 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001286 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001287 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001288 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1289 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1290 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001291
1292 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1293 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1294 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1295 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1296 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1297 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1298 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001299 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1300 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1301 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001302
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001303 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1304 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1305 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1306 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1307 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1308 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1309 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1310 URIs start with a leading "/".
1311
1312 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1313 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1314 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1315 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1316
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001317 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001318 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1319
1320 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1321 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
Willy Tarreau61a21a32011-03-01 20:35:49 +01001322 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1323 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001324 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1325 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1326 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1327 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1328 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1329 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1330 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1331 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1332 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1333 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1334 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1335 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1336 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1337 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1338 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1339 be randomly balanced if at all.
1340
1341 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1342 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1343 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1344 server will receive the request.
1345
1346 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1347 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1348 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1349 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1350 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001351 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1352 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1353 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001354
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001355 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001356 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1357 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001358 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001359 algorithm is applied instead.
1360
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001361 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001362 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1363 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1364 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1365
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001366 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1367 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1368 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1369
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001370 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001371 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001372 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1373 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1374 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1375 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1376 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1377 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001378 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001379 used instead.
1380
1381 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1382 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1383 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1384 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1385
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001386 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1387 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1388 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001390 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
1391
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001392 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001393 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1394 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001395
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001396 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001397 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001398
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001399 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1400 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1401 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001402
1403 Examples :
1404 balance roundrobin
1405 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001406 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001407 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1408 balance hdr(host)
1409 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001410
1411 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1412 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1413
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001414 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001415 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1416 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1417 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1418 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1419
1420 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1421 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1422 defaults to 16 kB.
1423
1424 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1425 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1426
1427 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1428 Round Robin.
1429
1430 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1431 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1432 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1433 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1434
1435 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1436
1437 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001438 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001439 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1440 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1441 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001442
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001443 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1444 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001445
1446
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001447bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1448bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1449bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1450bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1451bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1452bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1453bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001454bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001455bind /<path> [, ...]
1456bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1457bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1458bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001459 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1461 no | yes | yes | no
1462 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001463 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1464 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1465 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1466 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001467 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001468
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001469 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1470 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001471 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1472 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1473 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001474 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1475 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1476 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1477 the range.
1478
1479 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1480 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1481 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1482 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1483 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1484 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1485 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1486 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1487 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001488
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001489 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1490 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1491 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1492 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1493 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1494 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1495 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1496 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1497
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001498 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1499 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1500 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1501 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1502 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1503 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1504 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1505 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001506 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1507 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001508
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001509 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1510 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1511 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1512 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1513 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1514 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
Willy Tarreau48a7e722010-12-24 15:26:39 +01001515 work on other operating systems. It may also not change the
1516 advertised value but change the effective size of outgoing
1517 segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet networks
1518 is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is positive,
1519 it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it
1520 will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's
1521 advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This parameter is only
1522 compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001523
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001524 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1525 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1526 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1527 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001528
1529 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1530
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001531 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1532 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1533 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1534 simply ignore this.
1535
1536 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1537 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1538 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1539 simply ignore this.
1540
1541 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1542 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1543 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1544 this.
1545
1546 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1547 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1548 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1549 this.
1550
1551 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1552 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1553 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1554 this.
1555
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001556 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1557 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1558 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001559 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001560 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1561 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1562 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1563 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001564 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1565 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001566
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001567 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001568 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1569 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1570 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1571 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1572 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1573 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1574 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1575 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1576 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1577 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1578 with front firewalls which would see an established
1579 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1580
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001581 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1582 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1583 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1584 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1585 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1586 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1587 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1588 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1589 This keyword combined with support from external components
1590 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1591 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1592 not even always usable.
1593
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001594 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1595 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1596 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1597 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1598 in a frontend.
1599
1600 Example :
1601 listen http_proxy
1602 bind :80,:443
1603 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001604 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001605
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001606 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001607 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001608
1609
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001610bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1611 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1613 yes | yes | yes | yes
1614 Arguments :
1615 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1616 may be used to override a default value.
1617
1618 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1619 option may be combined with other numbers.
1620
1621 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1622 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1623 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1624 missing from all processes.
1625
1626 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1627 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1628 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1629 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1630
1631 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1632 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1633 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1634 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1635 and 'even' instances.
1636
1637 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1638 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1639 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1640 32.
1641
1642 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1643 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1644
1645 Example :
1646 listen app_ip1
1647 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001648 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001649
1650 listen app_ip2
1651 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001652 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001653
1654 listen management
1655 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001656 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001657
1658 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1659
1660
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001661block { if | unless } <condition>
1662 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1664 no | yes | yes | yes
1665
1666 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1667 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001668 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001669 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001670 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1671 "block" statements per instance.
1672
1673 Example:
1674 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1675 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1676 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1677 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001679 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001680
1681
1682capture cookie <name> len <length>
1683 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1685 no | yes | yes | no
1686 Arguments :
1687 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1688 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1689 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1690 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1691 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1692
1693 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1694 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1695 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1696 right if it exceeds <length>.
1697
1698 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1699 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1700 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1701 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1702
1703 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1704 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1705 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1706
1707 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1708 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1709 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1710 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001711 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001712 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1713
1714 Example:
1715 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1716
1717 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001718 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719
1720
1721capture request header <name> len <length>
1722 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1724 no | yes | yes | no
1725 Arguments :
1726 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001727 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001728 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1729 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1730 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1731
1732 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1733 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1734 it exceeds <length>.
1735
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001736 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001737 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1738 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001739 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1740 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1741 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1742 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001743 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001744 environments to find where the request came from.
1745
1746 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1747 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1748 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1749 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001750
1751 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1752 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1753 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1754 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1755
1756 Example:
1757 capture request header Host len 15
1758 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1759 capture request header Referrer len 15
1760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001761 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001762 about logging.
1763
1764
1765capture response header <name> len <length>
1766 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1768 no | yes | yes | no
1769 Arguments :
1770 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001771 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001772 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1773 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1774 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1775
1776 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1777 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1778 it exceeds <length>.
1779
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001780 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001781 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1782 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1783 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001784 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1785 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1786 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1787 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001788
1789 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1790 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1791 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1792 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1793
1794 Example:
1795 capture response header Content-length len 9
1796 capture response header Location len 15
1797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001798 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001799 about logging.
1800
1801
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001802clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001803 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1805 yes | yes | yes | no
1806 Arguments :
1807 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1808 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1809 as explained at the top of this document.
1810
1811 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1812 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1813 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1814 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1815 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1816 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1817 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1818 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001819 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001820 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1821 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1822
1823 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1824 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1825 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1826 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1827 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1828 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1829
1830 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1831 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1832
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001833 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1834 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001835
1836
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001837contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001838 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1840 yes | no | yes | yes
1841 Arguments :
1842 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1843 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1844 as explained at the top of this document.
1845
1846 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001847 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001848 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001849 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1850 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1851 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1852 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1853
1854 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1855 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1856 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1857 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1858 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1859 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1860
1861 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1862 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1863 instead.
1864
1865 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1866 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1867
1868
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001869cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001870 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001871 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001872 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1874 yes | no | yes | yes
1875 Arguments :
1876 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1877 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1878 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1879 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1880 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1881 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1882 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1883 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1884 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1885
1886 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1887 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1888 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1889 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1890 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1891 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1892 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1893 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1894 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1895 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1896 "insert" and "prefix".
1897
1898 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001899 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001900
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001901 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001902 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1903 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1904 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1905 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1906 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1907 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1908 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1909 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1910 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1911 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001912
1913 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1914 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1915 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1916 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1917 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1918 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1919 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1920 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1921 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1922 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001923 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1924 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1925 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001926
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001927 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1928 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1929 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001930 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1931 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1932 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1933 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001934 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1935 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1936 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001937
1938 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1939 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1940 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1941 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1942 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1943 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1944 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1945 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1946 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1947
1948 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1949 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1950 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1951 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1952 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1953 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1954 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1955 persistence cookie in the cache.
1956 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1957
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001958 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1959 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1960 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1961 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1962 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1963 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1964 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1965 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1966 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1967 they logout.
1968
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001969 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001970 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001971 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1972 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1973 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1974 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1975 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1976 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001977
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001978 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1979 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1980 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1981 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1982 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1983 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1984 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1985 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1986 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1987 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1988 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1989 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1990 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1991 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1992 the site.
1993
1994 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1995 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1996 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1997 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1998 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1999 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2000 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2001 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2002 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2003 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2004 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2005 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2006 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2007 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2008 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2009 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2010
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002011 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2012 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2013 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2014 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002015
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016 Examples :
2017 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2018 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2019 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002020 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002021
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002022 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002023 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002024
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002025
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002026default-server [param*]
2027 Change default options for a server in a backend
2028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2029 yes | no | yes | yes
2030 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002031 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2032 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2033 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2034 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002035
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002036 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002037 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2038
2039 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002040
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002041
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042default_backend <backend>
2043 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2045 yes | yes | yes | no
2046 Arguments :
2047 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2048
2049 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2050 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2051 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2052 will catch all undetermined requests.
2053
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054 Example :
2055
2056 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2057 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2058 default_backend dynamic
2059
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002060 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2061
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002062
2063disabled
2064 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2066 yes | yes | yes | yes
2067 Arguments : none
2068
2069 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2070 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2071 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2072 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2073 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2074 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2075 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2076
2077 See also : "enabled"
2078
2079
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002080dispatch <address>:<port>
2081 Set a default server address
2082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2083 no | no | yes | yes
2084 Arguments : none
2085
2086 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2087 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2088 during start-up.
2089
2090 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2091 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2092 possible with normal servers.
2093
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002094 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002095 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2096 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2097 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2098 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2099
2100 See also : "server"
2101
2102
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002103enabled
2104 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2106 yes | yes | yes | yes
2107 Arguments : none
2108
2109 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2110 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2111
2112 See also : "disabled"
2113
2114
2115errorfile <code> <file>
2116 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2118 yes | yes | yes | yes
2119 Arguments :
2120 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002121 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002122
2123 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002124 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002125 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002126 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2127 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002128
2129 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2130 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2131 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2132
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002133 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2134
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002135 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2136 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2137 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2138 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2139
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002140 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2141 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2142 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2143 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2144 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2145 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2146
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002147 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2148 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2149 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002150 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002151 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2152
2153 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2154
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002155 Example :
2156 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2157 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2158 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2159
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002160
2161errorloc <code> <url>
2162errorloc302 <code> <url>
2163 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2165 yes | yes | yes | yes
2166 Arguments :
2167 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002168 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002169
2170 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2171 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2172 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2173 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2174 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2175
2176 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2177 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2178 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2179
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002180 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2181
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002182 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2183 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2184 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2185 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2186 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2187 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2188 request.
2189
2190 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2191
2192
2193errorloc303 <code> <url>
2194 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2196 yes | yes | yes | yes
2197 Arguments :
2198 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2199 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2200
2201 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2202 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2203 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2204 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2205 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2206
2207 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2208 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2209 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2210
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002211 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2212
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002213 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2214 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2215 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2216 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002217 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002218
2219 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2220
2221
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002222force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2223 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2224 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2225 no | yes | yes | yes
2226
2227 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2228 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2229 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2230 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2231 marked down for maintenance operations.
2232
2233 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2234 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2235 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2236 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2237 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2238 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2239 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2240 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2241 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2242
2243 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2244 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2245 is used.
2246
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002247 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002248 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002249
2250
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002251fullconn <conns>
2252 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2254 yes | no | yes | yes
2255 Arguments :
2256 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2257 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2258
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002259 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002260 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002261 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002262 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2263 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2264 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2265 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2266 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002267 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002268
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002269 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2270 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2271 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2272
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002273 Example :
2274 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2275 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2276 # connections.
2277 backend dynamic
2278 fullconn 10000
2279 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2280 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2281
2282 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2283
2284
2285grace <time>
2286 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002288 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002289 Arguments :
2290 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2291 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2292 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2293
2294 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2295 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002296 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002297 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2298
2299 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2300 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2301 simplify it.
2302
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002303
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002304hash-type <method>
2305 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2307 yes | no | yes | yes
2308 Arguments :
2309 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2310 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2311 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2312 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2313 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2314 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2315 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2316 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2317 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2318
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002319 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2320 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2321 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2322 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2323 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2324 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2325 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2326 this value.
2327
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002328 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2329 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2330 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2331 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2332 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2333 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2334 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2335 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2336 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2337 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2338 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2339 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2340 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2341
2342 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2343
2344 See also : "balance", "server"
2345
2346
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002347http-check disable-on-404
2348 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002350 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002351 Arguments : none
2352
2353 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2354 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2355 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2356 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2357 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2358 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2359 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2360 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002361 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2362 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2363 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2364
2365 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2366
2367
2368http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2369 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002371 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002372 Arguments :
2373 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2374 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2375 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2376 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2377 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2378 details on the supported keywords.
2379
2380 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2381 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2382 with the usual backslash ('\').
2383
2384 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2385 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2386 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2387 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2388 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2389
2390 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2391 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2392 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2393 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2394 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2395
2396 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2397 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2398 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2399 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2400 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2401 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2402
2403 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2404 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2405 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2406 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2407 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2408 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2409 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2410 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2411 trace).
2412
2413 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2414 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2415 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2416 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2417 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2418 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2419 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2420 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2421
2422 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2423 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2424 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2425 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2426 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2427 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2428 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2429 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2430
2431 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2432 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2433
2434 Examples :
2435 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002436 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002437
2438 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002439 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002440
2441 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002442 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002443
2444 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002445 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002446
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002447 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002448
2449
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002450http-check send-state
2451 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2453 yes | no | yes | yes
2454 Arguments : none
2455
2456 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2457 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2458 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2459 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2460 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2461
2462 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2463 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2464 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2465 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2466 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2467 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2468 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2469 checked in multiple backends.
2470
2471 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2472 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2473
2474 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2475 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2476 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2477 one fails.
2478
2479 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2480 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2481 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2482
2483 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2484 server's queue.
2485
2486 Example of a header received by the application server :
2487 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2488 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2489
2490 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2491
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002492http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002493 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002494 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2495
2496 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2497 no | yes | yes | yes
2498
2499 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2500 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2501 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002502 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2503 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002504 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2505
2506 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2507 instance.
2508
2509 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002510 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2511 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2512 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002513
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002514 http-request allow if nagios
2515 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2516 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2517 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002518
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002519 Example:
2520 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002521
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002522 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002523
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002524 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2525 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002526
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002527http-send-name-header [<header>]
2528 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2529
2530 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2531 yes | no | yes | yes
2532
2533 Arguments :
2534
2535 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2536
2537 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2538 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2539 is added with the header string proved.
2540
2541 See also : "server"
2542
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002543id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002544 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2546 no | yes | yes | yes
2547 Arguments : none
2548
2549 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2550 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2551 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002552
2553
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002554ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2555 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2556 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2557 no | yes | yes | yes
2558
2559 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2560 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2561 and running).
2562
2563 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2564 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2565 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2566 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2567 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2568
2569 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2570 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2571
2572 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2573 "unless" condition is met.
2574
2575 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2576
2577
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002578log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002579log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002580no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002581 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2583 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002584
2585 Prefix :
2586 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2587 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2588 prefix does not allow arguments.
2589
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002590 Arguments :
2591 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2592 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2593 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2594 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2595 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2596 parameter.
2597
2598 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2599 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2600
2601 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2602 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2603 standard syslog port).
2604
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002605 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2606 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2607 standard syslog port).
2608
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002609 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2610 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2611 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2612 appropriately writeable).
2613
2614 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2615
2616 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2617 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2618 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2619
2620 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2621 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2622 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002623 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2624 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2625 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2626 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2627 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002628
2629 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2630
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002631 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2632 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2633 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002634
2635 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2636 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2637 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2638 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2639
2640 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2641 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002642
2643 Example :
2644 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002645 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2646 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002647
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002648log-format <string>
2649 Allows you to custom a log line.
2650
2651 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2652
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002653
2654maxconn <conns>
2655 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2657 yes | yes | yes | no
2658 Arguments :
2659 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2660 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2661 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2662 closes.
2663
2664 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2665 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2666 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2667 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2668 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2669 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2670 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2671 properly tuned.
2672
2673 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2674 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2675 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2676
2677 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2678
2679
2680mode { tcp|http|health }
2681 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2683 yes | yes | yes | yes
2684 Arguments :
2685 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2686 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2687 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2688 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2689
2690 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2691 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2692 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2693 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2694 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2695
2696 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2697 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2698 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2699 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2700 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2701 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2702
2703 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2704 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2705 will be refused.
2706
2707 Example :
2708 defaults http_instances
2709 mode http
2710
2711 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2712
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002713
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002714monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002715 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2717 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002718 Arguments :
2719 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2720 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002721 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002722 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2723 backend and its backup.
2724
2725 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2726 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2727 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2728 servers in a list of backends.
2729
2730 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2731 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2732 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2733 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2734 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2735 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2736 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002737 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2738 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002739
2740 Example:
2741 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002742 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002743 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2744 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2745 monitor-uri /site_alive
2746 monitor fail if site_dead
2747
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002748 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002749
2750
2751monitor-net <source>
2752 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2754 yes | yes | yes | no
2755 Arguments :
2756 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2757 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2758 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2759 followed by a mask.
2760
2761 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2762 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002763 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002764 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2765
2766 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2767 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2768 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2769 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2770 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2771
2772 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2773 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2774 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2775 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2776 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2777
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002778 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2779 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2780
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002781 Example :
2782 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2783 frontend www
2784 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2785
2786 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2787
2788
2789monitor-uri <uri>
2790 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2792 yes | yes | yes | no
2793 Arguments :
2794 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2795 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2796
2797 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2798 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2799 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2800 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2801 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2802 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2803 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2804 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2805
2806 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2807 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2808 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2809 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2810 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2811 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2812
2813 Example :
2814 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2815 frontend www
2816 mode http
2817 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2818
2819 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2820
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002821
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002822option abortonclose
2823no option abortonclose
2824 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2826 yes | no | yes | yes
2827 Arguments : none
2828
2829 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2830 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2831 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2832 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002833 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002834 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2835 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2836 encountered while delivering the response.
2837
2838 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2839 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2840 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2841 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2842 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2843 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002844 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002845 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002846 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002847 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2848 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2849 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2850
2851 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2852 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2853 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2854 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2855 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2856 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2857 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2858 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002859 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002860
2861 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2862 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2863
2864 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2865
2866
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002867option accept-invalid-http-request
2868no option accept-invalid-http-request
2869 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2871 yes | yes | yes | no
2872 Arguments : none
2873
2874 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2875 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2876 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2877 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2878 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2879 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2880 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2881 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002882 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2883 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2884 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2885 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2886 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2887 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002888
2889 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2890 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2891 been confirmed.
2892
2893 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2894 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002895 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2896 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002897 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2898
2899 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2900 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2901
2902 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2903 stats socket.
2904
2905
2906option accept-invalid-http-response
2907no option accept-invalid-http-response
2908 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2910 yes | no | yes | yes
2911 Arguments : none
2912
2913 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2914 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2915 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2916 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2917 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2918 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2919 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2920 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2921 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2922
2923 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2924 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2925 been confirmed.
2926
2927 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2928 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2929 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2930 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2931
2932 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2933 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2934
2935 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2936 stats socket.
2937
2938
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002939option allbackups
2940no option allbackups
2941 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2943 yes | no | yes | yes
2944 Arguments : none
2945
2946 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2947 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2948 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2949 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2950 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2951 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2952 order between the backup servers anymore.
2953
2954 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2955 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2956
2957 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2958 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2959
2960
2961option checkcache
2962no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002963 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2965 yes | no | yes | yes
2966 Arguments : none
2967
2968 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2969 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002970 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002971 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2972 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002973 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002974
2975 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002976 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002977 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002978 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2979 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002980 to the client are :
2981 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002982 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002983 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002984 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2985 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2986 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2987 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2988 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2989 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2990 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2991 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2992 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2993 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2994 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2995
2996 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002997 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002998 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002999 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003000 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3001
3002 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3003 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003004 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003005 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3006
3007 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3008 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3009
3010
3011option clitcpka
3012no option clitcpka
3013 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3015 yes | yes | yes | no
3016 Arguments : none
3017
3018 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3019 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3020 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3021 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3022
3023 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3024 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3025 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3026 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3027
3028 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3029 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3030 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3031 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3032 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3033
3034 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3035
3036 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3037 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3038 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3039
3040 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3041 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3042
3043 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3044
3045
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003046option contstats
3047 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3049 yes | yes | yes | no
3050 Arguments : none
3051
3052 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3053 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3054 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3055 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3056 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3057 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3058 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3059
3060
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003061option dontlog-normal
3062no option dontlog-normal
3063 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3065 yes | yes | yes | no
3066 Arguments : none
3067
3068 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3069 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3070 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3071 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3072 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3073 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3074 logged.
3075
3076 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3077 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3078 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3079
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003080 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003081 logging.
3082
3083
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003084option dontlognull
3085no option dontlognull
3086 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3088 yes | yes | yes | no
3089 Arguments : none
3090
3091 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3092 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3093 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3094 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3095 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3096 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3097 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3098
3099 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3100 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3101 would not be logged.
3102
3103 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3104 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003106 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003107
3108
3109option forceclose
3110no option forceclose
3111 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003113 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003114 Arguments : none
3115
3116 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3117 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3118 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3119 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3120 global session times in the logs.
3121
3122 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003123 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003124 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3125 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3126 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3127 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003128
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003129 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3130 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3131 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3132
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003133 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3134 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3135
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003136 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003137
3138
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003139option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003140 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3142 yes | yes | yes | yes
3143 Arguments :
3144 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3145 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003146 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003147 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003148
3149 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3150 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3151 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3152 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3153 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3154 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3155 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003156 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3157 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3158 possible that the client has already brought one.
3159
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003160 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003161 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003162 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3163 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003164 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3165 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003166
3167 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3168 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3169 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3170 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3171 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3172 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3173 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3174
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003175 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3176 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3177 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3178 are under the control of the end-user.
3179
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003180 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003181 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3182 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003183 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3184 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3185 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003186
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003187 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3188 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3189 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3190 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3191 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003192
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003193 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003194 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3195 frontend www
3196 mode http
3197 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3198
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003199 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3200 backend www
3201 mode http
3202 option forwardfor header X-Client
3203
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003204 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3205 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003206
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003207
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003208option http-no-delay
3209no option http-no-delay
3210 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3212 yes | yes | yes | yes
3213 Arguments : none
3214
3215 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3216 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3217 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3218 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3219 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3220 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3221 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3222 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3223 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3224 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3225 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3226 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3227 affected.
3228
3229 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3230 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3231 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3232 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3233 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3234 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3235 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3236 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3237 latency environments.
3238
3239
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003240option http-pretend-keepalive
3241no option http-pretend-keepalive
3242 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3244 yes | yes | yes | yes
3245 Arguments : none
3246
3247 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3248 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3249 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3250 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3251 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3252 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3253 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3254 consider the response complete.
3255
3256 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3257 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3258 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3259 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3260 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3261 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3262
3263 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3264 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3265 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3266 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3267 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3268 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3269 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3270
3271 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3272 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003273 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3274 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3275 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003276
3277 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3278 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3279
3280 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3281
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003282
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003283option http-server-close
3284no option http-server-close
3285 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3287 yes | yes | yes | yes
3288 Arguments : none
3289
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003290 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3291 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3292 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3293 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3294 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3295 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3296 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3297 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3298 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3299 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3300 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3301 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003302
3303 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3304 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3305 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3306 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003307 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3308 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003309
3310 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3311 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003312 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3313 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3314 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003315
3316 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3317 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3318
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003319 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3320 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003321
3322
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003323option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003324no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003325 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3327 yes | yes | yes | no
3328 Arguments : none
3329
3330 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3331 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3332 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3333 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3334 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3335 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3336 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3337
3338 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3339 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3340 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3341 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3342 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3343 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3344 request along its whole life.
3345
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003346 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3347 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3348 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3349 front of an existing proxy.
3350
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003351 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3352
3353 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3354 http-server-close".
3355
3356
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003357option httpchk
3358option httpchk <uri>
3359option httpchk <method> <uri>
3360option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3361 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3363 yes | no | yes | yes
3364 Arguments :
3365 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3366 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3367 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3368 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3369 ones.
3370
3371 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3372 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3373 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3374
3375 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3376 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3377 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3378 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3379 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3380
3381 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3382 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3383 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3384 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3385 the lack of any response.
3386
3387 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3388
3389 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3390 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3391 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3392
3393 Examples :
3394 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3395 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3396 backend https_relay
3397 mode tcp
3398 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3399 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3400
3401 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003402 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3403 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003404
3405
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003406option httpclose
3407no option httpclose
3408 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3410 yes | yes | yes | yes
3411 Arguments : none
3412
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003413 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3414 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3415 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3416 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3417 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3418 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3419 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003420
3421 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003422 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3423 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3424 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3425 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3426 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3427 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003428
3429 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3430 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3431 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003432 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3433 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003434
3435 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3436 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3437
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003438 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3439 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003440
3441
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003442option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003443 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3445 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003446 Arguments :
3447 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3448 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3449 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3450 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3451 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003452
3453 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3454 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3455 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3456 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3457 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3458 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3459 ports.
3460
3461 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3462
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003463 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3464 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3465 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3466 by default.
3467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003468 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003469
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003470
3471option http_proxy
3472no option http_proxy
3473 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3475 yes | yes | yes | yes
3476 Arguments : none
3477
3478 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3479 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3480 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3481 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3482 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3483
3484 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3485 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3486 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3487 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003488 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003489 be analyzed.
3490
3491 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3492 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3493
3494 Example :
3495 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3496 backend direct_forward
3497 option httpclose
3498 option http_proxy
3499
3500 See also : "option httpclose"
3501
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003502
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003503option independant-streams
3504no option independant-streams
3505 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3507 yes | yes | yes | yes
3508 Arguments : none
3509
3510 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3511 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3512 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3513 receive data or not.
3514
3515 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3516 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3517 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3518 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3519 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3520 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3521 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3522 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3523 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3524 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3525 socket buffers.
3526
3527 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3528 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3529 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3530 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3531 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3532
3533 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3534
3535
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003536option ldap-check
3537 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3539 yes | no | yes | yes
3540 Arguments : none
3541
3542 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3543 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3544 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3545 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3546
3547 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3548 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3549
3550 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3551 configure it.
3552
3553 Example :
3554 option ldap-check
3555
3556 See also : "option httpchk"
3557
3558
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003559option log-health-checks
3560no option log-health-checks
3561 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3563 yes | no | yes | yes
3564 Arguments : none
3565
3566 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3567 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3568 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3569 of additional information is limited.
3570
3571 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3572 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3573
3574 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3575
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003576
3577option log-separate-errors
3578no option log-separate-errors
3579 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3581 yes | yes | yes | no
3582 Arguments : none
3583
3584 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3585 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3586 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3587 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3588 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3589 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3590 provides very important information.
3591
3592 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3593 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3594 error logs.
3595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003596 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003597 logging.
3598
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003599
3600option logasap
3601no option logasap
3602 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3604 yes | yes | yes | no
3605 Arguments : none
3606
3607 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3608 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3609 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3610 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3611 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3612 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3613 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003614 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003615 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3616 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3617
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003618 Examples :
3619 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3620 mode http
3621 option httplog
3622 option logasap
3623 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3624
3625 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3626 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3627 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3628 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3629
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003630 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003631 logging.
3632
3633
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003634option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3635 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3637 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003638 Arguments :
3639 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3640 to MySQL server.
3641
3642 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3643 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3644 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3645 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3646 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3647 in the MySQL table, like this :
3648
3649 USE mysql;
3650 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3651 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3652
3653 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3654 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3655 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3656 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3657 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3658 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3659 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3660 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3661 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3662
3663 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3664 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003665
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003666 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003667
3668 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3669 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3670 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3671 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3672 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3673 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3674
3675 See also: "option httpchk"
3676
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003677option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3678 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3680 yes | no | yes | yes
3681 Arguments :
3682 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3683 to PostgreSQL server.
3684
3685 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3686 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3687 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3688 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3689
3690 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003691
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003692option nolinger
3693no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003694 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003695 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3696 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003697 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003698
3699 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3700 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3701 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3702 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3703 connections.
3704
3705 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3706 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3707 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3708 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3709 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3710 this too.
3711
3712 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3713 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3714 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3715
3716 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3717 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3718 for servers.
3719
3720 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3721 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3722
3723
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003724option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3725 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3727 yes | yes | yes | yes
3728 Arguments :
3729 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3730 matching <network>
3731 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3732 header name.
3733
3734 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3735 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3736 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3737 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3738 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3739 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3740 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3741 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3742 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3743 possible that the client has already brought one.
3744
3745 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3746 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3747 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3748 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3749 header and requires different one.
3750
3751 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3752 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3753 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3754 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3755 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3756 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3757 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3758
3759 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3760 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3761 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3762 both are defined.
3763
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003764 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3765 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3766 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3767 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3768 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003769
3770 Examples :
3771 # Original Destination address
3772 frontend www
3773 mode http
3774 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3775
3776 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3777 backend www
3778 mode http
3779 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3780
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003781 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3782 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003783
3784
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003785option persist
3786no option persist
3787 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3788 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3789 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003790 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003791
3792 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3793 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3794 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3795 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3796 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3797 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3798 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3799 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3800 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3801 redirected to another valid server.
3802
3803 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3804 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3805
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003806 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003807
3808
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003809option redispatch
3810no option redispatch
3811 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3812 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3813 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003814 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003815
3816 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3817 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3818 be able to access the service anymore.
3819
3820 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3821 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3822
3823 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3824 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3825 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003827 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3828 "redisp" keywords.
3829
3830 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3831 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3832
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003833 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003834
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003835
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003836option redis-check
3837 Use redis health checks for server testing
3838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3839 yes | no | yes | yes
3840 Arguments : none
3841
3842 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3843 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3844 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3845 find the "+PONG" response message.
3846
3847 Example :
3848 option redis-check
3849
3850 See also : "option httpchk"
3851
3852
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003853option smtpchk
3854option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3855 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3857 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003858 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003859 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3860 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3861 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3862
3863 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3864 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3865 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3866
3867 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3868 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3869 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3870 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3871 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3872 dead server.
3873
3874 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3875 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3876 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3877 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3878
3879 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3880 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3881 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3882 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3883 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3884
3885 Example :
3886 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3887
3888 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3889
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003891option socket-stats
3892no option socket-stats
3893
3894 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3896 yes | yes | yes | no
3897
3898 Arguments : none
3899
3900
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003901option splice-auto
3902no option splice-auto
3903 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3905 yes | yes | yes | yes
3906 Arguments : none
3907
3908 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3909 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3910 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3911 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003912 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003913 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3914 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3915 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3916 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3917
3918 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3919 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3920 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3921 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3922 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3923 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3924 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3925 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3926 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3927 keyword.
3928
3929 Example :
3930 option splice-auto
3931
3932 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3933 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3934
3935 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3936 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3937
3938
3939option splice-request
3940no option splice-request
3941 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3943 yes | yes | yes | yes
3944 Arguments : none
3945
3946 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3947 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3948 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3949 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3950 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3951 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3952
3953 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3954
3955 Example :
3956 option splice-request
3957
3958 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3959 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3960
3961 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3962 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3963
3964
3965option splice-response
3966no option splice-response
3967 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3969 yes | yes | yes | yes
3970 Arguments : none
3971
3972 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3973 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3974 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3975 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3976 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3977 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3978
3979 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3980
3981 Example :
3982 option splice-response
3983
3984 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3985 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3986
3987 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3988 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3989
3990
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003991option srvtcpka
3992no option srvtcpka
3993 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3995 yes | no | yes | yes
3996 Arguments : none
3997
3998 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3999 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4000 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4001 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4002
4003 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4004 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4005 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4006 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4007
4008 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4009 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4010 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4011 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4012 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4013
4014 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4015
4016 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4017 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4018 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4019
4020 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4021 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4022
4023 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4024
4025
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004026option ssl-hello-chk
4027 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4029 yes | no | yes | yes
4030 Arguments : none
4031
4032 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4033 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4034 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4035 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4036 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4037 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4038 hello message.
4039
4040 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4041 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4042 messages, which is appreciable.
4043
4044 See also: "option httpchk"
4045
4046
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004047option tcp-smart-accept
4048no option tcp-smart-accept
4049 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4051 yes | yes | yes | no
4052 Arguments : none
4053
4054 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4055 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4056 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4057 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4058 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4059 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4060
4061 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4062 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4063 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4064 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4065
4066 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4067 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4068 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4069 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4070
4071 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4072 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4073 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4074
4075 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4076 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4077 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4078
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004079 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4080
4081
4082option tcp-smart-connect
4083no option tcp-smart-connect
4084 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4086 yes | no | yes | yes
4087 Arguments : none
4088
4089 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4090 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4091 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4092 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4093 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4094
4095 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4096 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4097 complex.
4098
4099 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4100 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4101 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4102
4103 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4104 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4105
4106 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4107
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004108
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004109option tcpka
4110 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4112 yes | yes | yes | yes
4113 Arguments : none
4114
4115 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4116 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4117 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4118 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4119
4120 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4121 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4122 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4123 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4124
4125 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4126 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4127 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4128 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4129 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4130
4131 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4132
4133 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4134 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4135 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4136 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4137 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4138 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4139 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4140 backends.
4141
4142 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4143
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004144
4145option tcplog
4146 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4148 yes | yes | yes | yes
4149 Arguments : none
4150
4151 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4152 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4153 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4154 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4155 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4156 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4157 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4158 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4159
4160 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004162 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004163
4164
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004165option transparent
4166no option transparent
4167 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004169 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004170 Arguments : none
4171
4172 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4173 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4174 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4175 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4176 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4177 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4178 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4179 appropriate server.
4180
4181 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4182 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4183
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004184 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004185 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004186
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004187
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004188persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004189persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004190 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4192 yes | no | yes | yes
4193 Arguments :
4194 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004195 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4196 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004197
4198 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4199 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4200 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4201 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4202 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4203 forwarded to this server.
4204
4205 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4206 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4207 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004208 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004209 a single "listen" section.
4210
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004211 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4212 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4213 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4214
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004215 Example :
4216 listen tse-farm
4217 bind :3389
4218 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4219 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4220 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4221 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4222 persist rdp-cookie
4223 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
4224 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
4225 balance rdp-cookie
4226 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4227 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4228
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004229 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4230 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004231
4232
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004233rate-limit sessions <rate>
4234 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4236 yes | yes | yes | no
4237 Arguments :
4238 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4239 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4240
4241 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4242 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4243 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4244 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4245 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4246 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4247
4248 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4249 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4250 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4251 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4252
4253 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4254 listen smtp
4255 mode tcp
4256 bind :25
4257 rate-limit sessions 10
4258 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4259
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004260 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4261 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4262 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004263
4264 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4265
4266
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004267redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4268redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004269 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4271 no | yes | yes | yes
4272
4273 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004274 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004275
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004276 Arguments :
4277 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4278 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4279 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4280 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004281 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4282 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4283 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4284 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004285
4286 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4287 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4288 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4289 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4290 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4291 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4292 location with a GET method.
4293
4294 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4295 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4296
4297 - "drop-query"
4298 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4299 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4300 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4301 with a location-type redirect.
4302
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004303 - "append-slash"
4304 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4305 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4306 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4307 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4308
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004309 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4310 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4311 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4312 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4313 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4314 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4315 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4316
4317 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4318 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4319 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4320 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4321 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4322 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4323 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004324
4325 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4326 acl clear dst_port 80
4327 acl secure dst_port 8080
4328 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004329 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004330 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004331 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4332
4333 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004334 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4335 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4336 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004337 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004338
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004339 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4340 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4341 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004343 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004344
4345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004346redisp (deprecated)
4347redispatch (deprecated)
4348 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4349 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4350 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004351 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004352
4353 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4354 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4355 be able to access the service anymore.
4356
4357 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4358 redistribute them to a working server.
4359
4360 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4361 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4362 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004363
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004364 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4365 "option redispatch" instead.
4366
4367 See also : "option redispatch"
4368
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004369
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004370reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004371 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4373 no | yes | yes | yes
4374 Arguments :
4375 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4376 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004377 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004378
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004379 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4380 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4381
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004382 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4383 the last header of an HTTP request.
4384
4385 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4386 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4387 responses.
4388
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004389 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4390 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4391 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4392
4393 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4394 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004395
4396
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004397reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4398reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004399 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4401 no | yes | yes | yes
4402 Arguments :
4403 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4404 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4405 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4406 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4407 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4408 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4409 ignores case.
4410
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004411 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4412 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4413
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004414 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4415 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4416 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4417 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004418 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004419
4420 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4421 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4422
4423 Example :
4424 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4425 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4426 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4427
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004428 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4429 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004430
4431
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004432reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4433reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004434 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4436 no | yes | yes | yes
4437 Arguments :
4438 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4439 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4440 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4441 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4442 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4443 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4444
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004445 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4446 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4447
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004448 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4449 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4450 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4451 next servers.
4452
4453 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4454 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4455 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4456
4457 Example :
4458 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4459 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4460 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4461
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004462 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4463 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004464
4465
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004466reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4467reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004468 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4470 no | yes | yes | yes
4471 Arguments :
4472 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4473 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4474 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4475 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4476 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4477 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4478 case.
4479
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004480 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4481 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4482
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004483 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4484 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4485 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4486 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004487 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004488
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004489 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004490 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004491 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004492
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004493 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4494 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4495
4496 Example :
4497 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4498 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4499 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4500
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004501 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4502 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004503
4504
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004505reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4506reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004507 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4509 no | yes | yes | yes
4510 Arguments :
4511 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4512 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4513 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4514 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4515 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4516 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4517 case.
4518
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004519 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4520 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4521
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004522 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4523 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4524 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4525 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4526
4527 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4528 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4529
4530 Example :
4531 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4532 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4533 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4534 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4535
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004536 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4537 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004538
4539
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004540reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4541reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004542 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4544 no | yes | yes | yes
4545 Arguments :
4546 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4547 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4548 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4549 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4550 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4551 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4552
4553 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4554 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4555 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4556 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004557 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004558
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004559 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4560 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4561
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004562 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4563 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4564 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4565
4566 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4567 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4568 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4569 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4570 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4571
4572 Example :
4573 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4574 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4575 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4576 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4577
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004578 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4579 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004580
4581
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004582reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4583reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004584 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4586 no | yes | yes | yes
4587 Arguments :
4588 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4589 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4590 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4591 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4592 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4593 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4594 ignores case.
4595
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004596 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4597 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4598
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004599 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4600 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004601 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4602 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4603 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004604 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4605 not set.
4606
4607 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4608 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4609 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4610 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4611 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4612
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004613 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004614 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4615 # block all others.
4616 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4617 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4618
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004619 # block bad guys
4620 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4621 reqitarpit . if badguys
4622
4623 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4624 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004625
4626
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004627retries <value>
4628 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4629 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4630 yes | no | yes | yes
4631 Arguments :
4632 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4633 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4634 default value is 3.
4635
4636 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4637 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4638 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4639
4640 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4641 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4642
4643 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4644 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4645
4646 See also : "option redispatch"
4647
4648
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004649rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004650 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4652 no | yes | yes | yes
4653 Arguments :
4654 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4655 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004656 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004657
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004658 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4659 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4660
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004661 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4662 the last header of an HTTP response.
4663
4664 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4665 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4666 responses.
4667
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004668 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4669 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004670
4671
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004672rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4673rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004674 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4676 no | yes | yes | yes
4677 Arguments :
4678 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4679 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4680 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4681 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4682 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4683 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4684 ignores case.
4685
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004686 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4687 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4688
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004689 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4690 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004691 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004692 client.
4693
4694 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4695 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4696 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4697
4698 Example :
4699 # remove the Server header from responses
4700 reqidel ^Server:.*
4701
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004702 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4703 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004704
4705
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004706rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4707rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004708 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4710 no | yes | yes | yes
4711 Arguments :
4712 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4713 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4714 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4715 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4716 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4717 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4718 ignores case.
4719
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004720 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4721 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4722
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004723 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4724 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4725 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4726 case-sensitive.
4727
4728 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004729 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4730 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4731 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004732
4733 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4734 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4735
4736 Example :
4737 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4738 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4739
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004740 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4741 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004742
4743
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004744rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4745rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004746 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4748 no | yes | yes | yes
4749 Arguments :
4750 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4751 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4752 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4753 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4754 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4755 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4756 ignores case.
4757
4758 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4759 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4760 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4761 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004762 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004763
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004764 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4765 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4766
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004767 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4768 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4769 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4770
4771 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4772 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4773 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4774 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4775 are not case-sensitive.
4776
4777 Example :
4778 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4779 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4780
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004781 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4782 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004783
4784
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004785server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004786 Declare a server in a backend
4787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4788 no | no | yes | yes
4789 Arguments :
4790 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004791 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is
4792 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004793
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004794 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4795 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4796 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4797 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004798 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4799 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4800 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4801 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4802 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4803 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004804
4805 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4806 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4807 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4808 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4809 adding this value to the client's port.
4810
4811 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4812 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004813 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004814
4815 Examples :
4816 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4817 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4818
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004819 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4820 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004821
4822
4823source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004824source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004825source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004826 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4828 yes | no | yes | yes
4829 Arguments :
4830 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4831 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4832 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4833 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4834
4835 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4836 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004837 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4838 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4839 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004840
4841 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4842 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4843 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4844 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4845 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4846 <addr>.
4847
4848 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4849 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4850 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4851 port.
4852
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004853 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4854 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4855 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4856 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4857 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4858 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4859 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4860 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4861 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4862 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4863 HTTP header.
4864
4865 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4866 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4867 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4868 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4869 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4870 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4871 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4872 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4873 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4874 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4875
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004876 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4877 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4878 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4879 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4880 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4881 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4882
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004883 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4884 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4885 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4886 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4887
4888 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4889 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4890 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4891 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4892 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4893 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4894
4895 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4896 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4897 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4898 there are two methods :
4899
4900 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4901 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4902 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4903 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4904 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4905 of the client ranges may be used.
4906
4907 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4908 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4909 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4910 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4911 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4912 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4913 same session.
4914
4915 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4916 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4917 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4918 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4919 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4920 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4921
4922 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4923 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4924 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004925 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004926
4927 Examples :
4928 backend private
4929 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4930 source 192.168.1.200
4931
4932 backend transparent_ssl1
4933 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4934 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4935
4936 backend transparent_ssl2
4937 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4938 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4939 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4940
4941 backend transparent_ssl3
4942 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4943 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4944 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4945
4946 backend transparent_smtp
4947 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4948 # with Tproxy version 4.
4949 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4950
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004951 backend transparent_http
4952 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4953 # proxy.
4954 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004956 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004957 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4958
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004959
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004960srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4961 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4963 yes | no | yes | yes
4964 Arguments :
4965 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4966 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4967 as explained at the top of this document.
4968
4969 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4970 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4971 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4972 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4973 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4974 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4975 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4976
4977 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4978 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4979 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4980 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4981 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004982 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004983 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004984 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004985
4986 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4987 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4988 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4989 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4990 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4991 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4992
4993 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4994 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4995
4996 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4997
4998
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004999stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5000 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5002 no | no | yes | yes
5003
5004 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5005 matched.
5006
5007 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5008 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5009
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005010 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5011 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5012 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5013
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005014 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5015 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5016 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5017 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005018
5019 Example :
5020 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5021 backend stats_localhost
5022 stats enable
5023 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5024
5025 Example :
5026 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5027 backend stats_auth
5028 stats enable
5029 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5030 stats admin if TRUE
5031
5032 Example :
5033 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5034 userlist stats-auth
5035 group admin users admin
5036 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5037 group readonly users haproxy
5038 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5039
5040 backend stats_auth
5041 stats enable
5042 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5043 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5044 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5045 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5046
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005047 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5048 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5049 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005050
5051
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005052stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5053 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5055 yes | no | yes | yes
5056 Arguments :
5057 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5058
5059 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5060
5061 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5062 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5063 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5064 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5065 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5066 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5067
5068 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5069 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5070 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005071 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005072
5073 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5074 report using "stats scope".
5075
5076 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5077 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5078 unobvious parameters.
5079
5080 Example :
5081 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5082 backend public_www
5083 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5084 stats enable
5085 stats hide-version
5086 stats scope .
5087 stats uri /admin?stats
5088 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5089 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5090 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5091
5092 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5093 backend private_monitoring
5094 stats enable
5095 stats uri /admin?stats
5096 stats refresh 5s
5097
5098 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5099
5100
5101stats enable
5102 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5104 yes | no | yes | yes
5105 Arguments : none
5106
5107 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5108 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5109 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5110 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5111 - stats auth : no authentication
5112 - stats scope : no restriction
5113
5114 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5115 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5116 unobvious parameters.
5117
5118 Example :
5119 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5120 backend public_www
5121 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5122 stats enable
5123 stats hide-version
5124 stats scope .
5125 stats uri /admin?stats
5126 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5127 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5128 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5129
5130 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5131 backend private_monitoring
5132 stats enable
5133 stats uri /admin?stats
5134 stats refresh 5s
5135
5136 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5137
5138
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005139stats hide-version
5140 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5142 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005143 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005144
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005145 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5146 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5147 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5148 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5149 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5150 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005152 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5153 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5154 unobvious parameters.
5155
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005156 Example :
5157 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5158 backend public_www
5159 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005160 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005161 stats hide-version
5162 stats scope .
5163 stats uri /admin?stats
5164 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5165 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5166 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005167
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005168 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5169 backend private_monitoring
5170 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005171 stats uri /admin?stats
5172 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005173
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005174 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005175
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005176
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005177stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5178 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5179 Access control for statistics
5180
5181 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5182 no | no | yes | yes
5183
5184 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5185 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5186 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5187 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5188 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5189 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5190
5191 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5192 instance.
5193
5194 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5195 about ACL usage.
5196
5197
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005198stats realm <realm>
5199 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5201 yes | no | yes | yes
5202 Arguments :
5203 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5204 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5205 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5206
5207 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5208 using a backslash ('\').
5209
5210 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5211 only related to authentication.
5212
5213 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5214 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5215 unobvious parameters.
5216
5217 Example :
5218 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5219 backend public_www
5220 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5221 stats enable
5222 stats hide-version
5223 stats scope .
5224 stats uri /admin?stats
5225 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5226 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5227 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5228
5229 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5230 backend private_monitoring
5231 stats enable
5232 stats uri /admin?stats
5233 stats refresh 5s
5234
5235 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5236
5237
5238stats refresh <delay>
5239 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5241 yes | no | yes | yes
5242 Arguments :
5243 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5244 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5245 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5246 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5247 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5248 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5249
5250 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5251 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5252 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5253 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5254
5255 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5256 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5257 unobvious parameters.
5258
5259 Example :
5260 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5261 backend public_www
5262 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5263 stats enable
5264 stats hide-version
5265 stats scope .
5266 stats uri /admin?stats
5267 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5268 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5269 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5270
5271 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5272 backend private_monitoring
5273 stats enable
5274 stats uri /admin?stats
5275 stats refresh 5s
5276
5277 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5278
5279
5280stats scope { <name> | "." }
5281 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5283 yes | no | yes | yes
5284 Arguments :
5285 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5286 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5287 section in which the statement appears.
5288
5289 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5290 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5291 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5292 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5293 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5294 exists.
5295
5296 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5297 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5298 unobvious parameters.
5299
5300 Example :
5301 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5302 backend public_www
5303 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5304 stats enable
5305 stats hide-version
5306 stats scope .
5307 stats uri /admin?stats
5308 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5309 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5310 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5311
5312 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5313 backend private_monitoring
5314 stats enable
5315 stats uri /admin?stats
5316 stats refresh 5s
5317
5318 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5319
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005320
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005321stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005322 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5324 yes | no | yes | yes
5325
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005326 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005327 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5328
5329 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5330 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5331
5332 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5333 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5334 unobvious parameters.
5335
5336 Example :
5337 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5338 backend private_monitoring
5339 stats enable
5340 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5341 stats uri /admin?stats
5342 stats refresh 5s
5343
5344 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5345 global section.
5346
5347
5348stats show-legends
5349 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5350 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5351 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5352 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5353 - IP (socket, server)
5354 - cookie (backend, server)
5355
5356 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5357 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5358 unobvious parameters.
5359
5360 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5361
5362
5363stats show-node [ <name> ]
5364 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5366 yes | no | yes | yes
5367 Arguments:
5368 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5369 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5370
5371 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5372 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5373 provided for each customer.
5374
5375 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5376 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5377 unobvious parameters.
5378
5379 Example:
5380 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5381 backend private_monitoring
5382 stats enable
5383 stats show-node Europe-1
5384 stats uri /admin?stats
5385 stats refresh 5s
5386
5387 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5388 section.
5389
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005390
5391stats uri <prefix>
5392 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5394 yes | no | yes | yes
5395 Arguments :
5396 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5397 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5398 query string.
5399
5400 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5401 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5402 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5403 possible to reach it in the application.
5404
5405 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005406 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005407 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5408 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5409 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5410 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5411
5412 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5413 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5414 an address or a port to statistics only.
5415
5416 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5417 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5418 unobvious parameters.
5419
5420 Example :
5421 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5422 backend public_www
5423 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5424 stats enable
5425 stats hide-version
5426 stats scope .
5427 stats uri /admin?stats
5428 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5429 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5430 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5431
5432 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5433 backend private_monitoring
5434 stats enable
5435 stats uri /admin?stats
5436 stats refresh 5s
5437
5438 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5439
5440
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005441stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5442 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005444 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005445
5446 Arguments :
5447 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5448 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5449 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5450 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5451
5452 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5453 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5454 the "stick-table" statement.
5455
5456 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5457 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5458 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5459 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5460 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5461
5462 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5463 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5464 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5465 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5466 transformation rules.
5467
5468 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5469 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5470 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5471 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5472 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5473 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5474 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5475
5476 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5477 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5478 ACL based conditions.
5479
5480 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5481 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5482 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5483 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5484
5485 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5486 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5487 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5488 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5489
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005490 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5491 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5492 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5493
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005494 Example :
5495 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5496 # last 30 minutes
5497 backend pop
5498 mode tcp
5499 balance roundrobin
5500 stick store-request src
5501 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5502 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5503 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5504
5505 backend smtp
5506 mode tcp
5507 balance roundrobin
5508 stick match src table pop
5509 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5510 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5511
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005512 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5513 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005514
5515
5516stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5517 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5519 no | no | yes | yes
5520
5521 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5522 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5523 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5524 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5525
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005526 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5527 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5528 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5529
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005530 Examples :
5531 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005532 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005533
5534 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5535 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5536 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5537
5538
5539 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5540 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5541 backend http
5542 mode http
5543 balance roundrobin
5544 stick on src table https
5545 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5546 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5547 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5548
5549 backend https
5550 mode tcp
5551 balance roundrobin
5552 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5553 stick on src
5554 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5555 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5556
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005557 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005558
5559
5560stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5561 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5563 no | no | yes | yes
5564
5565 Arguments :
5566 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5567 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5568 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5569 server is selected.
5570
5571 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5572 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5573 the "stick-table" statement.
5574
5575 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5576 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5577 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5578 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5579 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5580 address.
5581
5582 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5583 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5584 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5585 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5586 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5587 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5588 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5589 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5590 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5591 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5592
5593 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5594 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5595 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5596 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5597 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5598 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5599 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5600
5601 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5602 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5603 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5604 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5605
5606 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5607 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5608 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5609 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5610 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5611 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5612 another protocol or access method.
5613
5614 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5615 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5616 the request.
5617
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005618 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5619 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5620 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5621
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005622 Example :
5623 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5624 # last 30 minutes
5625 backend pop
5626 mode tcp
5627 balance roundrobin
5628 stick store-request src
5629 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5630 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5631 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5632
5633 backend smtp
5634 mode tcp
5635 balance roundrobin
5636 stick match src table pop
5637 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5638 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5639
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005640 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5641 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005642
5643
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005644stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005645 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5646 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005647 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005649 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005650
5651 Arguments :
5652 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5653 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5654 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5655 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5656
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005657 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5658 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5659 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5660 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5661
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005662 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5663 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5664 instance.
5665
5666 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5667 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5668 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5669 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5670 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5671 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005672 to 32 characters.
5673
5674 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5675 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5676 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5677 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5678 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5679 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005680
5681 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005682 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5683 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005684 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5685 increase.
5686
5687 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005688 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5689 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5690 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005691
5692 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5693 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5694 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5695 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5696 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5697 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5698 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5699 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5700 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5701 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5702 parameter (see below).
5703
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005704 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5705 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5706 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5707 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5708 soft restart.
5709
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005710 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5711
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005712 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5713 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5714 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5715 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5716 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5717 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5718 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5719 if not expiration delay is specified.
5720
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005721 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5722 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5723 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5724 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005725 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5726 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5727 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5728 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5729 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5730 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5731 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5732 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5733 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5734 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5735 types and their arguments.
5736
5737 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5738 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5739 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5740 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5741
5742 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5743 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5744 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5745 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5746
5747 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5748 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5749 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5750 they were received.
5751
5752 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5753 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5754 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5755 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5756 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5757
5758 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5759 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5760 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5761 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5762 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5763
5764 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5765 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5766 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5767
5768 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5769 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5770 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5771 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5772 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5773
5774 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5775 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5776 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5777 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5778 the client side.
5779
5780 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5781 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5782 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5783 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5784 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5785 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5786 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5787
5788 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5789 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5790 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5791 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5792 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5793 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5794 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5795
5796 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5797 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5798 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5799 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5800 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5801 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5802
5803 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5804 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5805 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5806 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5807
5808 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5809 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5810 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5811 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5812 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5813 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5814 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5815 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5816 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5817 recommended for better fairness.
5818
5819 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5820 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5821 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5822 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5823
5824 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5825 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5826 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5827 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5828 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5829 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5830 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5831 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5832 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5833 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005834
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005835 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5836 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005837 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5838 reference it.
5839
5840 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5841 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5842 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5843 as an exclusive stickiness.
5844
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005845 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5846 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5847 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5848 something that can be ignored.
5849
5850 Example:
5851 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5852 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5853 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5854 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5855
5856 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005857 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005858
5859
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005860stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5861 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5863 no | no | yes | yes
5864
5865 Arguments :
5866 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5867 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5868 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5869 server is selected.
5870
5871 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5872 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5873 the "stick-table" statement.
5874
5875 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5876 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5877 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5878 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5879
5880 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5881 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5882 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5883 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5884 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5885 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
5886 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
5887 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5888 rules.
5889
5890 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5891 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5892 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5893 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5894 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5895 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5896 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5897
5898 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5899 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5900 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5901 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5902
5903 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5904 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5905 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5906 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5907 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5908 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5909 another protocol or access method.
5910
5911 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5912
5913 Example :
5914 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5915 backend https
5916 mode tcp
5917 balance roundrobin
5918 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
5919 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
5920
5921 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5922 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5923
5924 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5925 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5926 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5927
5928 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5929 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
5930
5931 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5932 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5933 # at offset 44.
5934
5935 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5936 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5937
5938 # Learn on response if server hello.
5939 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
5940
5941 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5942 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5943
5944 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5945 extraction.
5946
5947
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005948tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5949 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5951 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005952 Arguments :
5953 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5954 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5955 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005956
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005957 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005958
5959 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5960 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005961 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5962 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5963 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5964 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5965 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5966 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005967
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005968 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5969 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5970 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5971 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005972
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005973 Three types of actions are supported :
5974 - accept :
5975 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5976 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5977 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005978
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005979 - reject :
5980 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5981 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5982 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5983 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5984 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5985 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5986 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5987 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5988 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5989 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5990 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5991 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005992
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005993 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5994 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5995 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5996 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5997 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5998 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5999 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6000 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6001 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006002
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006003 These actions take one or two arguments :
6004 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6005 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6006 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006007
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006008 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6009 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6010 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6011 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006012
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006013 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6014 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6015 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6016 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6017 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6018 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6019 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6020 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6021 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6022 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006023
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006024 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6025 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6026 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006028 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6029 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6030 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006031
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006032 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006033 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006034 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006035
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006036 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6037 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6038 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006039
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006040 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6041 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6042 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006043
6044 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6045
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006046 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006047
6048
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006049tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6050 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006052 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006053 Arguments :
6054 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6055 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6056 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006058 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006059
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006060 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6061 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6062 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6063 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6064 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006065
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006066 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6067 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6068 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6069 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6070 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6071 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6072 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6073 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6074 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006075
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006076 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6077 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6078 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6079 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006080
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006081 Three types of actions are supported :
6082 - accept :
6083 - reject :
6084 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006085
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006086 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6087 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006088
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006089 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6090 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6091 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6092 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6093 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6094 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006095
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006096 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006097 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6098 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006099
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006100 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
6101 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
6102 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6103 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6104 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006105
6106 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006107 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6108 # and reject everything else.
6109 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6110 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6111 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
6112 tcp-request content reject
6113
6114 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006115 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6116 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6117 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006118 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006119
6120 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6121 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6122 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006123 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006124 tcp-request content reject
6125
6126 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6127 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6128
6129 frontend http
6130 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6131 # protecting all our sites
6132 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6133 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6134 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6135 ...
6136 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6137
6138 backend http_dynamic
6139 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6140 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6141 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6142 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6143 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6144 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6145 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006146
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006147 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006148
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006149 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006150
6151
6152tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6153 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006155 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006156 Arguments :
6157 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6158 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6159 as explained at the top of this document.
6160
6161 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6162 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6163 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6164 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6165 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6166
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006167 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6168 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6169 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6170 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6171
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006172 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6173 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006174 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006175 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006176 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6177 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6178 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6179 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006180
6181 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6182 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6183 it pass through unaffected.
6184
6185 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6186 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6187 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006188 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006189 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6190 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006191 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6192 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6193 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006194
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006195 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006196 "timeout client".
6197
6198
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006199tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6200 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6202 no | no | yes | yes
6203 Arguments :
6204 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6205 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6206 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6207
6208 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6209
6210 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6211 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6212 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6213 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
6214 set and expires with no matching rule.
6215
6216 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6217
6218 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6219 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6220 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6221 inserted.
6222
6223 Two types of actions are supported :
6224 - accept :
6225 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6226 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6227 the rules evaluation.
6228
6229 - reject :
6230 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6231 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6232 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6233
6234 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6235 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6236 for changing the default action to a reject.
6237
6238 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6239 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6240 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6241 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6242 period.
6243
6244 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6245
6246 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6247
6248
6249tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6250 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6252 no | no | yes | yes
6253 Arguments :
6254 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6255 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6256 as explained at the top of this document.
6257
6258 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6259
6260
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006261timeout check <timeout>
6262 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6263 established.
6264
6265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6266 yes | no | yes | yes
6267 Arguments:
6268 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6269 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6270 as explained at the top of this document.
6271
6272 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6273 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6274 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6275 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006276 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6277 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6278 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006279
6280 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6281 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6282
6283 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6284 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006285 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006286
6287 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6288 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6289 forget about it.
6290
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006291 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6292 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006293
6294
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006295timeout client <timeout>
6296timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6297 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6299 yes | yes | yes | no
6300 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006301 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006302 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6303 as explained at the top of this document.
6304
6305 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6306 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6307 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6308 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6309 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6310 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6311 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6312 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006313 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006314 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
6315 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
6316
6317 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6318 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6319 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6320 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6321 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6322 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6323
6324 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6325 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6326 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6327
6328 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
6329
6330
6331timeout connect <timeout>
6332timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6333 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6335 yes | no | yes | yes
6336 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006337 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006338 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6339 as explained at the top of this document.
6340
6341 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006342 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006343 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006344 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006345 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6346 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006347
6348 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6349 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6350 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6351 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6352 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6353 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6354
6355 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6356 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6357 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6358
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006359 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6360 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006361
6362
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006363timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6364 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6366 yes | yes | yes | yes
6367 Arguments :
6368 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6369 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6370 as explained at the top of this document.
6371
6372 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6373 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6374 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6375 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6376 once the request has started to present itself.
6377
6378 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6379 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6380 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6381 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6382 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6383
6384 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6385 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6386 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6387 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6388
6389 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6390 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6391 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6392 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6393 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006394 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006395
6396 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6397 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6398 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6399 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6400
6401 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6402
6403
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006404timeout http-request <timeout>
6405 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006407 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006408 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006409 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006410 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6411 as explained at the top of this document.
6412
6413 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6414 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6415 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6416 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6417 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6418 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6419 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6420 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6421
6422 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6423 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006424 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6425 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006426
6427 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6428 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6429 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6430 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6431 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6432
6433 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006434 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6435 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6436 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006437
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006438 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006439
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006440
6441timeout queue <timeout>
6442 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6444 yes | no | yes | yes
6445 Arguments :
6446 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6447 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6448 as explained at the top of this document.
6449
6450 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6451 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6452 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6453 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6454 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6455
6456 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6457 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6458 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6459 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6460
6461 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6462
6463
6464timeout server <timeout>
6465timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6466 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6468 yes | no | yes | yes
6469 Arguments :
6470 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6471 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6472 as explained at the top of this document.
6473
6474 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6475 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6476 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6477 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6478 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6479 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6480 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6481
6482 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6483 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6484 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6485 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6486 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006487 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006488 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006489 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006490
6491 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6492 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6493 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6494 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6495 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6496 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6497
6498 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6499 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6500 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6501
6502 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6503
6504
6505timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006506 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6508 yes | yes | yes | yes
6509 Arguments :
6510 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6511 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6512 as explained at the top of this document.
6513
6514 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6515 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6516 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6517
6518 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6519 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6520 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6521 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006522 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006523
6524 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6525
6526
6527transparent (deprecated)
6528 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006530 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006531 Arguments : none
6532
6533 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6534 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6535 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6536 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6537 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6538 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6539 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6540 appropriate server.
6541
6542 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6543
6544 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6545 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6546
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006547 See also: "option transparent"
6548
6549
6550use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6551use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006552 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6554 no | yes | yes | no
6555 Arguments :
6556 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006558 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006559
6560 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6561 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6562 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006563 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6564 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6565 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6566 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006567
6568 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6569 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6570 assign the backend.
6571
6572 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6573 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6574 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6575 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6576 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6577 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6578
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006579 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006580 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006581 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6582 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6583 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6584
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006585 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006586
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006587
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010065885. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006589------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006590
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006591The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6592which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6593arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6594settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6595after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6596Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6597address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006598
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006599 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006600 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006601
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006602The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006604addr <ipv4>
6605 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6606 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6607 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6608 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6609 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006611 Supported in default-server: No
6612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006613backup
6614 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6615 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6616 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6617 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6618 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6619 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006620
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006621 Supported in default-server: No
6622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006623check
6624 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01006625 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
6626 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
6627 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
6628 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
6629 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
6630 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
6631 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
6632 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
6633 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
6634 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006636 Supported in default-server: No
6637
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006638cookie <value>
6639 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6640 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6641 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6642 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6643 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6644 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6645 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6646
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006647 Supported in default-server: No
6648
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006649disabled
6650 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6651 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6652 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6653 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6654 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6655
6656 Supported in default-server: No
6657
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006658error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006659 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6660 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6661 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006662
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006663 Supported in default-server: Yes
6664
6665 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006666
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006667fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006668 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6669 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6670 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6671
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006672 Supported in default-server: Yes
6673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006674id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006675 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6676 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6677 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006679 Supported in default-server: No
6680
6681inter <delay>
6682fastinter <delay>
6683downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006684 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6685 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6686 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6687 between checks depending on the server state :
6688
6689 Server state | Interval used
6690 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6691 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6692 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6693 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6694 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6695 or yet unchecked. |
6696 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6697 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6698 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006699
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006700 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6701 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6702 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6703 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6704 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6705 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6706 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6707 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6708 servers.
6709
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006710 Supported in default-server: Yes
6711
6712maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006713 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6714 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6715 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6716 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6717 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6718 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6719 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6720 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6721
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006722 Supported in default-server: Yes
6723
6724maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006725 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6726 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6727 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6728 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6729 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6730 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6731 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6732
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006733 Supported in default-server: Yes
6734
6735minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006736 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6737 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6738 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6739 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6740 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6741 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006742 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006743 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006744
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006745 Supported in default-server: Yes
6746
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09006747non-stick
6748 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
6749 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
6750 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
6751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006752observe <mode>
6753 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6754 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6755 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6756 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6757 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6758 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6759 headers, a timeout, etc.
6760
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006761 Supported in default-server: No
6762
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006763 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6764
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006765on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006766 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6767 Currently, four modes are available:
6768 - fastinter: force fastinter
6769 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6770 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6771 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6772 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006774 Supported in default-server: Yes
6775
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006776 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6777
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09006778on-marked-down <action>
6779 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
6780 Currently one action is available:
6781 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions
6782
6783 Actions are disabled by default
6784
6785 Supported in default-server: Yes
6786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006787port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006788 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6789 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6790 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6791 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6792 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6793 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006795 Supported in default-server: Yes
6796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006797redir <prefix>
6798 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6799 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6800 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6801 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6802 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6803 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6804 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6805 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006806 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006807 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6808 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6809 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6810 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6811 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6812
6813 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6814
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006815 Supported in default-server: No
6816
6817rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006818 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6819 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6820 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006822 Supported in default-server: Yes
6823
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01006824send-proxy
6825 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
6826 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
6827 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
6828 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
6829 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
6830 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
6831 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
6832 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
6833 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
6834 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
6835 option of the "bind" keyword.
6836
6837 Supported in default-server: No
6838
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006839slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006840 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6841 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6842 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6843 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6844 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6845 parameters :
6846
6847 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6848 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6849
6850 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6851 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6852 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6853 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6854
6855 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6856 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6857 seen as failed.
6858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006859 Supported in default-server: Yes
6860
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006861source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006862source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006863source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006864 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6865 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6866 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6867 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6868
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006869 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6870 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6871 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6872 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6873 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6874 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6875 server.
6876
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006877 Supported in default-server: No
6878
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006879track [<proxy>/]<server>
6880 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6881 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6882 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6883 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6884 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6885
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006886 Supported in default-server: No
6887
6888weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006889 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6890 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6891 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006892 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6893 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6894 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6895 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6896 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6897 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006899 Supported in default-server: Yes
6900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006901
69026. HTTP header manipulation
6903---------------------------
6904
6905In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6906response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6907request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6908which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6909against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6910to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6911passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6912headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6913never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6914
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006915There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6916(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6917rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6918messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6919in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006920happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006921add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6922normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006924This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6925in section 4.2 :
6926
6927 - reqadd <string>
6928 - reqallow <search>
6929 - reqiallow <search>
6930 - reqdel <search>
6931 - reqidel <search>
6932 - reqdeny <search>
6933 - reqideny <search>
6934 - reqpass <search>
6935 - reqipass <search>
6936 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6937 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6938 - reqtarpit <search>
6939 - reqitarpit <search>
6940 - rspadd <string>
6941 - rspdel <search>
6942 - rspidel <search>
6943 - rspdeny <search>
6944 - rspideny <search>
6945 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6946 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6947
6948With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6949is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6950parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6951prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6952Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6953
6954 \t for a tab
6955 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6956 \n for a new line (LF)
6957 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6958 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6959 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6960 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6961 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6962
6963The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6964portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6965above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6966regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
69679 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6968is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6969
6970The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6971after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6972
6973Notes related to these keywords :
6974---------------------------------
6975 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6976 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6977 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6978
6979 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6980 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6981 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6982
6983 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6984 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6985 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6986 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6987 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6988
6989 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6990 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6991 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6992 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6993 useless headers before adding new ones.
6994
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006995 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006996 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6997
6998 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6999 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7000 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7001
7002 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7003 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007004 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007005
7006
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010070077. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7008------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007009
7010The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7011content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7012from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7013simple :
7014
7015 - define test criteria with sets of values
7016 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7017
7018The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7019
7020In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7021
7022 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7023
7024This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7025Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7026and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7027an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7028of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7029
7030ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7031'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7032which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7033
7034There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7035performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7036
7037The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7038
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007039 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7040 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007041 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7042
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007043The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7044specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7045possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007046multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7047be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7048needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7049space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7050match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7051lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7052duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
7053to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
7054instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007055
7056 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7057
7058In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7059the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7060case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7061too.
7062
7063Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7064a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7065ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7066
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007067Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007068
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007069 - integers or integer ranges
7070 - strings
7071 - regular expressions
7072 - IP addresses and networks
7073
7074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070757.1. Matching integers
7076----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007077
7078Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7079that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7080expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7081may be omitted.
7082
7083For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7084unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7085representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7086
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007087As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7088two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7089instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7090ranges and operators.
7091
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007092For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007093operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7094Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7095of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007096
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007097Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007098
7099 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7100 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7101 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7102 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7103 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7104
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007105For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007106
7107 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7108
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007109This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7110
7111 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7112
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007113
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071147.2. Matching strings
7115---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007116
7117String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7118exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7119characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7120string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7121to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007122before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007123
7124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071257.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7126-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007127
7128Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7129they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7130possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7131passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7132the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007133the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7134match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007135
7136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071377.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
7138----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007139
7140IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7141netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7142within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007143host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007144difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7145at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7146does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7147parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007148
7149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071507.5. Available matching criteria
7151--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071537.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7154------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007155
7156A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7157analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
7158addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
7159
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007160always_false
7161 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7162 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7163
7164always_true
7165 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7166 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7167
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007168avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007169avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007170 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7171 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7172 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7173 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7174 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7175 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7176 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7177 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7178 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7179 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7180 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007181
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007182be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007183be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007184 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7185 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7186 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7187 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7188 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007189
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007190be_id <integer>
7191 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7192 backend it was called.
7193
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007194be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007195be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007196 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7197 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7198 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7199 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7200 sucking of an online dictionary).
7201
7202 Example :
7203 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7204 backend dynamic
7205 mode http
7206 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7207 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007208
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007209connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007210connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007211 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007212 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007213 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7214
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007215 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7216 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007217
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007218 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007219 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7220 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7221 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7222 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7223 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007224 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007225
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007226 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7227 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7228 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7229 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007230
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007231dst <ip_address>
7232 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
7233 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007234
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007235dst_conn <integer>
7236 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7237 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7238 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7239 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7240 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7241 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7242
7243dst_port <integer>
7244 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7245 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7246
7247fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007248fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007249 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7250 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7251 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7252 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7253 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7254 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7255 criteria.
7256
7257fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007258 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007259 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007260
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007261fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007262fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007263 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7264 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7265 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7266 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7267 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7268 the rate to go down below the limit.
7269
7270 Example :
7271 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7272 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7273 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7274 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7275 frontend mail
7276 bind :25
7277 mode tcp
7278 maxconn 100
7279 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7280 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7281 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7282 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007283
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007284nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007285nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007286 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7287 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7288 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7289 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7290 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007291
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007292queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007293queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007294 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7295 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7296 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7297 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7298 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7299 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7300 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7301
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007302sc1_bytes_in_rate
7303sc2_bytes_in_rate
7304 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7305 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7306 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7307
7308sc1_bytes_out_rate
7309sc2_bytes_out_rate
7310 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7311 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7312 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7313
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007314sc1_clr_gpc0
7315sc2_clr_gpc0
7316 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7317 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7318 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7319 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7320 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7321 was verified :
7322
7323 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7324 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7325 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7326 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7327 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7328 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7329 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7330
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007331sc1_conn_cnt
7332sc2_conn_cnt
7333 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7334 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7335
7336sc1_conn_cur
7337sc2_conn_cur
7338 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7339 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7340 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7341
7342sc1_conn_rate
7343sc2_conn_rate
7344 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7345 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7346 See also src_conn_rate.
7347
7348sc1_get_gpc0
7349sc2_get_gpc0
7350 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7351 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7352
7353sc1_http_err_cnt
7354sc2_http_err_cnt
7355 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7356 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7357 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7358
7359sc1_http_err_rate
7360sc2_http_err_rate
7361 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7362 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7363 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7364 src_http_err_rate.
7365
7366sc1_http_req_cnt
7367sc2_http_req_cnt
7368 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7369 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7370 src_http_req_cnt.
7371
7372sc1_http_req_rate
7373sc2_http_req_rate
7374 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7375 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7376 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7377 src_http_req_rate.
7378
7379sc1_inc_gpc0
7380sc2_inc_gpc0
7381 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7382 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7383 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7384 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7385 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7386 when a first ACL was verified :
7387
7388 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7389 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7390 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7391
7392sc1_kbytes_in
7393sc2_kbytes_in
7394 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7395 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7396 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7397 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7398
7399sc1_kbytes_out
7400sc2_kbytes_out
7401 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7402 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7403 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7404 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7405
7406sc1_sess_cnt
7407sc2_sess_cnt
7408 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7409 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7410 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7411 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7412 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7413 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7414
7415sc1_sess_rate
7416sc2_sess_rate
7417 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7418 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7419 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7420 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7421 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7422 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7423
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007424so_id <integer>
7425 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7426
7427src <ip_address>
7428 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
7429 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
7430 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
7431
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007432src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007433src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007434 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7435 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7436 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007437 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007438
7439src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007440src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007441 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7442 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7443 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007444 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007445
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007446src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7447src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7448 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7449 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7450 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7451 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7452 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7453 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7454
7455 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7456 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7457 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7458 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7459 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7460 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7461 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7462
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007463src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007464src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007465 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7466 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7467 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007468 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007469
7470src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007471src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007472 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7473 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7474 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007475 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007476
7477src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007478src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007479 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7480 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7481 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007482 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007483
7484src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007485src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007486 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7487 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7488 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007489 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007490
7491src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007492src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007493 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7494 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7495 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007496 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007497
7498src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007499src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007500 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7501 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7502 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7503 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007504 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007505
7506src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007507src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007508 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7509 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7510 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007511 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007512
7513src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007514src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007515 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7516 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7517 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7518 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007519 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007520
7521src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007522src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007523 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7524 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7525 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7526 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7527 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7528 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7529
7530 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7531 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007532 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007533
7534src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007535src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007536 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7537 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7538 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7539 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007540 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007541
7542src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007543src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007544 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7545 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7546 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7547 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007548 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007549
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007550src_port <integer>
7551 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007552
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007553src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007554src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007555 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7556 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7557 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7558 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007559 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007560
7561src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007562src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007563 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7564 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7565 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7566 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007567 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007568
7569src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007570src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007571 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007572 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7573 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007574 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7575 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7576 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007577 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007578
7579 Example :
7580 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7581 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7582 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7583 listen ssh
7584 bind :22
7585 mode tcp
7586 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007587 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007588 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7589 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7590
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007591srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02007592 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
7593 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
7594 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
7595 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
7596
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007597srv_id <integer>
7598 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7599
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007600srv_is_up(<server>)
7601srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7602 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7603 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7604 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7605 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7606 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7607 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7608 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7609 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7610
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007611table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007612table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007613 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7614 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7615
7616table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007617table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007618 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7619 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7620 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7621
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007622
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020076237.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7624---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007625
7626A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7627during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007628through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7629keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007630
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007631rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7632 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7633 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7634 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7635 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7636
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007637req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007638 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007639 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7640 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7641 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7642 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7643 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7644 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7645
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007646req_proto_http
7647 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7648 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007649 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007650 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7651 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7652
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007653req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007654req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007655 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7656 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7657 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7658 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7659 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7660 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7661 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7662 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7663
7664req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007665req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007666 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7667 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7668 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7669 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7670 cookies.
7671
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007672req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7673 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7674 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7675 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7676 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7677
7678req_ssl_sni <string>
7679 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7680 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
7681 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
7682 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
7683 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
7684 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
7685 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
7686 hello (type 1), like in the example below.
7687
7688 Examples :
7689 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
7690 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7691 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
7692 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
7693 default_backend bk_sorry_page
7694
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007695req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7696 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7697 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7698 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7699 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7700 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7701 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7702 with TCP request content inspection.
7703
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007704wait_end
7705 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7706 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7707 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7708 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7709 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7710 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7711 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7712 inspection.
7713
7714 Examples :
7715 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7716 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7717 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7718
7719 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7720 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7721 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7722 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7723 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7724 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7725 tcp-request content reject
7726
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007727
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077287.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7729--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007730
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007731A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007732application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7733read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7734than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7735
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007736hdr <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007737hdr(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007738 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7739 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7740 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7741 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7742 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7743
7744 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7745 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7746 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7747
7748 hdr(Connection) -i close
7749
7750hdr_beg <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007751hdr_beg(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007752 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7753 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7754 response headers sent by the server.
7755
7756hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007757hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007758 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7759 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7760 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7761 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7762 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7763 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7764 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7765
7766hdr_dir <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007767hdr_dir(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007768 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7769 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7770 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7771 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7772 headers sent by the server.
7773
7774hdr_dom <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007775hdr_dom(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007776 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7777 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7778 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7779 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7780 server.
7781
7782hdr_end <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007783hdr_end(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007784 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7785 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7786 response headers sent by the server.
7787
7788hdr_ip <ip_address>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007789hdr_ip(<header>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007790 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7791 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7792 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7793 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7794
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02007795hdr_len <integer>
7796hdr_len(<header>) <integer>
7797 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
7798 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
7799 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7800 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7801
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007802hdr_reg <regex>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007803hdr_reg(<header>) <regex>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007804 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7805 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7806 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7807 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7808 response headers sent by the server.
7809
7810hdr_sub <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007811hdr_sub(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007812 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7813 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7814 response headers sent by the server.
7815
7816hdr_val <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007817hdr_val(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007818 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7819 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7820 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7821 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7822
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007823http_auth(<userlist>)
7824http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007825 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7826 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7827 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7828 of specified groups.
7829
7830 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7831
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02007832http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02007833 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
7834 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
7835 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
7836 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
7837
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007838method <string>
7839 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7840 already check for most common methods.
7841
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007842path <string>
7843 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7844 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7845 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7846
7847path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007848 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7849 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007850
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007851path_dir <string>
7852 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7853 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7854 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7855 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7856
7857path_dom <string>
7858 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7859 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7860 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7861
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007862path_end <string>
7863 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7864 control file name extension.
7865
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02007866path_len <integer>
7867 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
7868 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
7869
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007870path_reg <regex>
7871 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7872 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7873 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7874
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007875path_sub <string>
7876 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7877 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7878 "path_dir".
7879
7880req_ver <string>
7881 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7882 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7883
7884status <integer>
7885 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7886 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7887 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7888
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007889url <string>
7890 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7891 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7892
7893url_beg <string>
7894 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7895 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7896
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007897url_dir <string>
7898 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7899 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7900 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7901 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7902
7903url_dom <string>
7904 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7905 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7906 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7907
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007908url_end <string>
7909 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7910 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007911
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007912url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007913 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7914 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007915 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007916
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02007917url_len <integer>
7918 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
7919 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
7920
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007921url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007922 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7923 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007924 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007925 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007926
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007927url_reg <regex>
7928 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7929 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7930 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007931
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007932url_sub <string>
7933 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7934 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007935
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007936
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079377.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7938---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007939
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007940Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7941every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007942order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007943
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007944ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7945---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007946FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007947HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007948HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7949HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007950HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7951HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7952HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7953HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7954LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007955METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7956METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7957METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7958METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7959METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7960METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007961RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007962REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007963TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007964WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7965---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007966
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079687.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7969----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007970
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007971Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7972combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007974 - AND (implicit)
7975 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7976 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007977
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007978A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007979
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007980 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007982Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7983indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007984
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007985For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7986"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7987requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7988is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007990 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7991 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7992 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7993 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007995To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7996and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007998 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7999 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8000 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8001 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008003 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8004 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8005 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8006 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008007
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008008It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8009expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8010be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
8011the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
8012
8013 The following rule :
8014
8015 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8016 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8017
8018 Can also be written that way :
8019
8020 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8021
8022It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8023to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8024simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8025sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8026good use is the following :
8027
8028 With named ACLs :
8029
8030 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8031 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8032 monitor fail if site_dead
8033
8034 With anonymous ACLs :
8035
8036 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008038See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008039
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008040
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010080417.8. Pattern extraction
8042-----------------------
8043
8044The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8045response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8046for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8047
8048All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8049"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8050begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8051arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8052much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8053equivalent used in ACLs.
8054
8055The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8056
8057 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008058 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8059 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8060 according to RFC 4291.
8061
8062 src6 This is the source IPv6 address of the client of the session.
8063 It is of type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008064
8065 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8066 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8067 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008068 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8069 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8070 according to RFC 4291.
8071
8072 dst6 This is the destination IPv6 address of the session on the
8073 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8074 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008075 type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008076
8077 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8078 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8079 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8080 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8081 type integer and only works with such tables.
8082
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01008083 hdr(<name>) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
8084 request. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
8085 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008086
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008087 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008088 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8089 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8090 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8091 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008092
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008093 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008094 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8095 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8096 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8097 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8098 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8099 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8100 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8101 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
8102
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008103 url_param(<name>)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008104 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008105 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008106 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url (e.g.
8107 http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
8108 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
8109
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008110 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008111 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8112 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8113 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8114 done if there is no msts cookie present.
8115
8116 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8117 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8118 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8119 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8120 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8121 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8122 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
8123
8124 Example :
8125 listen tse-farm
8126 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8127 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8128 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8129 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8130 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8131 persist rdp-cookie
8132 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8133 # This is only useful makes sense if
8134 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8135 stick-table type string size 204800
8136 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8137 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8138 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
8139
8140 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8141 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
8142
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008143 cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008144 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8145 "Cookie" header line from the request and uses the corresponding
8146 value to match. A typical use is to get multiple clients sharing
8147 a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
8148 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with
8149 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across
8150 restarts.
8151
8152 See also : "appsession"
8153
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008154 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008155 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8156 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8157 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8158 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8159 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
8160
8161 See also : "appsession"
8162
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008163
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008164The currently available list of transformations include :
8165
8166 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8167 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8168 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8169
8170 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8171 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8172 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8173
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008174 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008175 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8176 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8177 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8178 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8179
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081818. Logging
8182----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008183
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008184One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8185provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8186very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8187provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8188state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008189to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008190headers.
8191
8192In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8193about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8194send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8195
8196 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8197 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8198 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8199 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8200 at the termination.
8201
8202The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8203allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8204as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8205while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8206real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8207delay.
8208
8209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082108.1. Log levels
8211---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008212
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008213TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008214source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008215HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8216in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8217track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8218syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8219about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008220
8221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082228.2. Log formats
8223----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008224
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008225HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008226and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8227slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8228options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008229
8230 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8231 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8232 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8233 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8234 extents.
8235
8236 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8237 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8238 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8239 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8240 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8241
8242 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8243 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8244 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8245 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8246 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8247
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008248 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8249 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8250 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8251 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8252
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008253 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
8254
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008255Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8256specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8257field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8258servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8259always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8260identifier.
8261
8262Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8263 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8264 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8265 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8266 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8267
8268
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082698.2.1. Default log format
8270-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008271
8272This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8273as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8274format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8275
8276 Example :
8277 listen www
8278 mode http
8279 log global
8280 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8281
8282 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8283 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8284 (www/HTTP)
8285
8286 Field Format Extract from the example above
8287 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8288 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8289 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8290 4 'to' to
8291 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8292 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8293
8294Detailed fields description :
8295 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8296 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8297 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8298 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8299 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8300 and processed the connection.
8301 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8302
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008303In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8304"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8305connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8306
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008307It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8308will eventually disappear.
8309
8310
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083118.2.2. TCP log format
8312---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008313
8314The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8315is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8316information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8317counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8318emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8319environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8320the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8321sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008322specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8323not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8324fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8325marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008326
8327 Example :
8328 frontend fnt
8329 mode tcp
8330 option tcplog
8331 log global
8332 default_backend bck
8333
8334 backend bck
8335 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8336
8337 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8338 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8339 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8340
8341 Field Format Extract from the example above
8342 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8343 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8344 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8345 4 frontend_name fnt
8346 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8347 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8348 7 bytes_read* 212
8349 8 termination_state --
8350 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8351 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8352
8353Detailed fields description :
8354 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008355 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8356 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8357 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8358 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8359 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008360
8361 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008362 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8363 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8364 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008365
8366 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8367 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8368 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8369 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8370
8371 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8372 and processed the connection.
8373
8374 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8375 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8376 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8377 applications.
8378
8379 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8380 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8381 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8382 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8383 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8384
8385 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8386 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8387 See "Timers" below for more details.
8388
8389 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8390 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8391 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8392 "Timers" below for more details.
8393
8394 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8395 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8396 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8397 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8398 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8399 details.
8400
8401 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8402 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8403 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8404 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8405 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8406
8407 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8408 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8409 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8410 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8411 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8412 for more details.
8413
8414 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8415 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8416 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8417 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8418 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008419 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008420
8421 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8422 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8423 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8424 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8425 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8426 caused by a denial of service attack.
8427
8428 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8429 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8430 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8431 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8432 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8433 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8434 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8435 denial of service attack.
8436
8437 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8438 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8439 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8440 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8441 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8442 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8443 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8444 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8445 be processed than on other servers.
8446
8447 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8448 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8449 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8450 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8451 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8452 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8453 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8454 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8455 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8456 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8457 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8458 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8459 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8460
8461 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8462 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8463 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8464 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8465 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8466 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8467 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8468 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8469
8470 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8471 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8472 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8473 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8474 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8475 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8476 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8477 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8478 occurs.
8479
8480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084818.2.3. HTTP log format
8482----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008483
8484The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8485is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8486the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8487are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8488emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8489generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8490"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8491which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008492frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8493is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008494
8495Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8496slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8497with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8498
8499 Example :
8500 frontend http-in
8501 mode http
8502 option httplog
8503 log global
8504 default_backend bck
8505
8506 backend static
8507 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8508
8509 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8510 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8511 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008512 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008513
8514 Field Format Extract from the example above
8515 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8516 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8517 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8518 4 frontend_name http-in
8519 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8520 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8521 7 status_code 200
8522 8 bytes_read* 2750
8523 9 captured_request_cookie -
8524 10 captured_response_cookie -
8525 11 termination_state ----
8526 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8527 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8528 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8529 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8530 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008531
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008532
8533Detailed fields description :
8534 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008535 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8536 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8537 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8538 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8539 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008540
8541 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008542 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8543 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8544 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008545
8546 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8547 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8548 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8549 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8550 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8551
8552 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8553 and processed the connection.
8554
8555 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8556 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8557 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8558
8559 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8560 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8561 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8562 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8563 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8564 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8565
8566 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8567 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8568 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8569 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8570 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8571 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8572
8573 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8574 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8575 See "Timers" below for more details.
8576
8577 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8578 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8579 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8580 below for more details.
8581
8582 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8583 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8584 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8585 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8586 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8587 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8588 for more details.
8589
8590 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8591 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8592 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8593 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8594 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8595 details.
8596
8597 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8598 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8599 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8600
8601 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8602 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8603 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8604 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8605 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8606 overflowing.
8607
8608 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8609 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8610 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8611 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8612 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8613 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8614 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8615 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8616
8617 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8618 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8619 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8620 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8621 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8622 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8623 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8624 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8625
8626 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8627 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8628 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8629 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8630 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8631 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8632 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8633
8634 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8635 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8636 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8637 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8638 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008639 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008640 system.
8641
8642 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8643 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8644 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8645 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8646 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8647 caused by a denial of service attack.
8648
8649 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8650 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8651 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8652 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8653 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8654 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8655 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8656 denial of service attack.
8657
8658 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8659 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8660 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8661 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8662 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8663 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8664 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8665 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
8666 processed than on other servers.
8667
8668 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8669 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8670 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8671 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8672 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8673 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8674 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8675 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8676 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8677 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8678 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8679 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8680 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8681
8682 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8683 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8684 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8685 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8686 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8687 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8688 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8689 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8690
8691 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8692 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8693 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8694 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8695 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8696 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8697 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8698 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8699 occurs.
8700
8701 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
8702 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
8703 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
8704 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
8705 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
8706 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
8707 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
8708 cookies" below for more details.
8709
8710 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
8711 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
8712 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
8713 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
8714 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
8715 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
8716 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
8717 and cookies" below for more details.
8718
8719 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
8720 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
8721 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
8722 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
8723 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
8724 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
8725 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
8726 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
8727
8728
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010087298.2.4 Custom log format
8730-----------------------
8731
8732The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode. It takes a
8733string as argument.
8734
8735HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
8736Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
8737separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
8738prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
8739
8740Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
8741variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
8742string formats ("Q").
8743
8744Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
8745HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
8746
8747Flags are :
8748 * Q: quote a string
8749
8750 Example:
8751
8752 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
8753 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
8754
8755At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
8756
8757 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
8758 %cs\ %ts\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
8759
8760And the default CLF format is defined this way :
8761
8762 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
8763 %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %ts\ %ac\ %fc\ \
8764 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
8765
8766Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
8767
8768 +------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
8769 | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
8770 +------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
8771 | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
8772 +------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
8773 | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
8774 | %Ci | client_ip | string |
8775 | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
8776 | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
8777 | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
8778 | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
8779 | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
8780 | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
8781 | %ac | actconn | numeric |
8782 | %b | backend_name | string |
8783 | %bc | beconn | numeric |
8784 | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
8785 | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
8786 | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
8787 | %f | frontend_name | string |
8788 | %fc | feconn | numeric |
8789 | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
8790 | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
8791 | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
8792 | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
8793 | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
8794 | %r | http_request | string |
8795 | %rc | retries | numeric |
8796 | %s | server_name | string |
8797 | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
8798 | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
8799 | %st | status_code | numeric |
8800 | %ts | termination_state | string |
8801 +------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
8802
8803
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088048.3. Advanced logging options
8805-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008806
8807Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
8808just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
8809options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
8810for more information about their usage.
8811
8812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088138.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
8814------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008815
8816It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
8817haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
8818commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
8819monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
8820ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
8821
8822 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
8823 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
8824 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
8825 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
8826
8827 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
8828 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
8829 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
8830 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
8831 such as other load-balancers.
8832
8833 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
8834 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
8835 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
8836
8837
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088388.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
8839----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008840
8841The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
8842what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
8843or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
8844"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8845just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8846log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8847after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8848is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8849with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8850with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8851
8852
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088538.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8854------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008855
8856Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
8857for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
8858"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
8859retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
8860raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
8861a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
8862file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
8863you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
8864"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
8865
8866
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088678.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
8868--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008869
8870Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
8871multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
8872them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
8873"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
8874logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
8875error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
8876and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
8877too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
8878useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
8879alternative.
8880
8881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088828.4. Timing events
8883------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008884
8885Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
8886reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
8887the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
8888frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
8889mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
8890
8891 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
8892 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
8893 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
8894 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
8895 the client closes prematurely or times out.
8896
8897 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8898 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8899 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8900 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8901 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8902
8903 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8904 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8905 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8906 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8907 connection never established.
8908
8909 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8910 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8911 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8912 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8913 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8914 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8915 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8916 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8917 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8918 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8919 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8920
8921 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8922 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8923 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8924 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8925 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8926
8927 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8928
8929 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8930 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8931 negative.
8932
8933These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8934protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8935that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008936due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008937close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8938session has been aborted on timeout.
8939
8940Most common cases :
8941
8942 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8943 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8944 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8945 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8946 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8947 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8948 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8949 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8950 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008951 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8952 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8953 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008954
8955 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8956 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8957 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8958 of ms on remote networks.
8959
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008960 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8961 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8962 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008963
8964 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8965 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8966 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8967 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8968 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8969 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8970 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8971 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8972 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8973 to the server until another one is released.
8974
8975Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8976
8977 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8978 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8979 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8980
8981 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8982 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8983 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8984
8985 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8986 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8987 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8988 flags.
8989
8990 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8991 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8992 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8993 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8994 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8995 the client connection was maintained open.
8996
8997 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8998 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8999 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
9000 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
9001
9002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090038.5. Session state at disconnection
9004-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009005
9006TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
9007"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
90082-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
9009each of which has a special meaning :
9010
9011 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
9012 session to terminate :
9013
9014 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
9015
9016 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
9017 server explicitly refused it.
9018
9019 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
9020 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
9021 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
9022 error in server response which might have caused information leak
9023 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
9024 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
9025
9026 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
9027 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
9028 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
9029 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
9030 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
9031
9032 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
9033 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
9034 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
9035 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
9036 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
9037
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09009038 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
9039 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
9040
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02009041 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
9042
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009043 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
9044 send or receive data.
9045
9046 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
9047 send or receive data.
9048
9049 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
9050 with nothing left in the buffers.
9051
9052 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
9053
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01009054 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009055 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
9056
9057 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
9058 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
9059 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
9060 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
9061 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
9062
9063 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
9064 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
9065
9066 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
9067 server (HTTP only).
9068
9069 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
9070
9071 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
9072 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
9073 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
9074
9075 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
9076 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
9077 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
9078
9079 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
9080
9081 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
9082 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
9083
9084 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
9085 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
9086 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
9087
9088 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
9089 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02009090 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
9091 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009092
9093 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
9094 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
9095 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
9096 another server.
9097
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009098 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009099 server.
9100
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009101 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
9102 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
9103 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
9104 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9105
9106 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
9107 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
9108 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
9109 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9110
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009111 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9112
9113 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
9114 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
9115
9116 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
9117
9118 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
9119 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
9120 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
9121
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009122 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
9123 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
9124 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
9125 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
9126 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
9127
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009128 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
9129
9130 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
9131 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
9132
9133 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
9134
9135 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9136
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009137The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
9138was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009139helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
9140starvation, attacks, etc...
9141
9142The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
9143alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
9144easier finding and understanding.
9145
9146 Flags Reason
9147
9148 -- Normal termination.
9149
9150 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
9151 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
9152 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
9153 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
9154
9155 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
9156 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
9157 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
9158 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
9159 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
9160 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009161
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009162 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9163 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
9164 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
9165
9166 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
9167 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
9168 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
9169
9170 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
9171 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
9172 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
9173 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
9174 the server takes too long to respond.
9175
9176 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
9177 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
9178 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
9179 long a time to respond.
9180
9181 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
9182 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
9183 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
9184 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
9185 and the client.
9186
9187 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
9188 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
9189 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
9190 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
9191 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
9192 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
9193
9194 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
9195 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009196 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
9197 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
9198 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
9199 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009200
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009201 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009202 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
9203 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
9204 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
9205 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
9206 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
9207
9208 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
9209 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
9210 503 or 504 here.
9211
9212 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
9213 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
9214 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
9215 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
9216 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
9217
9218 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9219 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009220 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009221 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
9222 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
9223
9224 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
9225 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
9226 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
9227 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
9228 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
9229 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
9230 between haproxy and the server.
9231
9232 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
9233 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
9234 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
9235 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
9236 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
9237 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
9238 solution is to fix the application.
9239
9240 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
9241 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
9242 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
9243 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
9244 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
9245 external attacks.
9246
9247 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
9248 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
9249 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
9250 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
9251 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
9252
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009253 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
9254 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
9255 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
9256 the client.
9257
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009258 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
9259 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
9260 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
9261 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009262 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
9263 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
9264 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
9265 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
9266 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009267
9268 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
9269 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
9270 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
9271 returned an HTTP 403 error.
9272
9273 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
9274 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9275 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9276 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9277
9278 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9279 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9280 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9281 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9282
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009283The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9284persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9285important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9286re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9287
9288 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9289
9290 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9291 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9292 set on a GET request.
9293
9294 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9295 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
9296 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
9297 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
9298
9299 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
9300 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
9301 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
9302
9303 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9304 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
9305 already got a cookie.
9306
9307 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9308 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
9309 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
9310 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
9311 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
9312
9313 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9314 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9315 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9316
9317 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
9318 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9319 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9320
9321 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
9322 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
9323
9324 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
9325 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
9326 then advertised in the response.
9327
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009328
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093298.6. Non-printable characters
9330-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009331
9332In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
9333consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
9334converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
9335prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
9336being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
9337escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
9338is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
9339'}' when logging headers.
9340
9341Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
9342issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
9343containing spaces is "User-Agent".
9344
9345Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
9346the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
9347performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
9348
9349
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093508.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
9351---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009352
9353Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
9354achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009355section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009356cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
9357the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
9358the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009359locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009360not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
9361user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
9362a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
9363wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
9364
9365 Examples :
9366 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
9367 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
9368
9369 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
9370 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
9371
9372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093738.8. Capturing HTTP headers
9374---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009375
9376Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
9377proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
9378the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
9379server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
9380
9381Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
9382response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009383section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009384
9385It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009386time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
9387appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009388are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
9389and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
9390follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
9391request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
9392in the logs.
9393
9394 Example :
9395 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
9396 listen proxy-out
9397 mode http
9398 option httplog
9399 option logasap
9400 log global
9401 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
9402
9403 # log the name of the virtual server
9404 capture request header Host len 20
9405
9406 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
9407 capture request header Content-Length len 10
9408
9409 # log the beginning of the referrer
9410 capture request header Referer len 20
9411
9412 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
9413 capture response header Server len 20
9414
9415 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
9416 capture response header Content-Length len 10
9417
9418 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
9419 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
9420
9421 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
9422 capture response header Via len 20
9423
9424 # log the URL location during a redirection
9425 capture response header Location len 20
9426
9427 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
9428 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
9429 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9430 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
9431 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
9432
9433 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9434 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9435 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9436 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009437 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009438
9439 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9440 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9441 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9442 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
9443 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009444 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009445
9446
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094478.9. Examples of logs
9448---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009449
9450These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9451them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9452reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9453
9454 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9455 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9456 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9457
9458 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9459 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9460
9461 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9462 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9463 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9464
9465 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9466 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9467
9468 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9469 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9470 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9471
9472 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009473 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009474 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9475 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9476
9477 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9478 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9479 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9480
9481 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9482 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009483 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009484 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9485 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9486 to return the 502 and not the server.
9487
9488 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009489 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009490
9491 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9492 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9493 Nothing was sent to any server.
9494
9495 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9496 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9497
9498 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9499 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9500 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9501 send a 408 return code to the client.
9502
9503 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9504 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9505
9506 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9507 5 seconds ("c----").
9508
9509 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9510 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009511 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009512
9513 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009514 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009515 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9516 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9517 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9518 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9519 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009520
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095229. Statistics and monitoring
9523----------------------------
9524
9525It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9526mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9527CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9528Unix socket.
9529
9530
95319.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009532---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009533
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009534The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9535page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9536
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009537 0. pxname: proxy name
9538 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9539 for server)
9540 2. qcur: current queued requests
9541 3. qmax: max queued requests
9542 4. scur: current sessions
9543 5. smax: max sessions
9544 6. slim: sessions limit
9545 7. stot: total sessions
9546 8. bin: bytes in
9547 9. bout: bytes out
9548 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009549 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009550 12. ereq: request errors
9551 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009552 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009553 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9554 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009555 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009556 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9557 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9558 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9559 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9560 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9561 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9562 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9563 25. qlimit: queue limit
9564 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9565 27. iid: unique proxy id
9566 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9567 29. throttle: warm up status
9568 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9569 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009570 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009571 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9572 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9573 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009574 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009575 UNK -> unknown
9576 INI -> initializing
9577 SOCKERR -> socket error
9578 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9579 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9580 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9581 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9582 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9583 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9584 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9585 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9586 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9587 disable-on-404
9588 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9589 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9590 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009591 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9592 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009593 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9594 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9595 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9596 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9597 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9598 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009599 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9600 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9601 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9602 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009603 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9604 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009605
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096079.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009608-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009609
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009610The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009611must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9612is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9613a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9614risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9615followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9616given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9617then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9618to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009619
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009620It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9621on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9622own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009623
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009624clear counters
9625 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9626 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9627 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9628 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9629 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9630
9631clear counters all
9632 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9633 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9634 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9635
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009636clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
9637 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
9638
9639 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
9640 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
9641 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
9642 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
9643 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
9644 later after the session ends is usual enough.
9645
9646 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
9647
9648 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
9649 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
9650 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
9651 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
9652 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
9653 the ACLs :
9654
9655 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9656 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9657 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9658 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9659 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9660 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9661
9662 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +09009663 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
9664 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009665
9666 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009667 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009668 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009669 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9670 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9671 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9672 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009673
9674 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9675
9676 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009677 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009678 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9679 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009680 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9681 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9682 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009683
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +02009684disable frontend <frontend>
9685 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
9686 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
9687 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
9688 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
9689 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
9690 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
9691 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
9692 on the stats page.
9693
9694 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
9695 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9696
9697 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9698 level "admin".
9699
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009700disable server <backend>/<server>
9701 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
9702 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
9703 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
9704 during the maintenance.
9705
9706 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
9707 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
9708
9709 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009710 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009711
9712 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9713 level "admin".
9714
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +02009715enable frontend <frontend>
9716 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
9717 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
9718 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
9719 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
9720 which was disabled.
9721
9722 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
9723 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9724
9725 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9726 level "admin".
9727
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009728enable server <backend>/<server>
9729 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
9730 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
9731
9732 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009733 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009734
9735 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9736 level "admin".
9737
9738get weight <backend>/<server>
9739 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
9740 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
9741 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
9742 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
9743 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009744 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009745
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009746help
9747 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
9748 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009749
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009750prompt
9751 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
9752 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
9753 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
9754 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
9755 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
9756 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
9757 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
9758 command.
9759
9760quit
9761 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009762
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +02009763set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
9764 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null
9765 positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn
9766 does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were
9767 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
9768 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
9769 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
9770 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9771
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +02009772set maxconn global <maxconn>
9773 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
9774 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
9775 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
9776 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
9777 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
9778 setting.
9779
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +02009780set rate-limit connections global <value>
9781 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
9782 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
9783 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
9784 is passed in number of connections per second.
9785
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009786set timeout cli <delay>
9787 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
9788 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
9789 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
9790
9791set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
9792 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
9793 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
9794 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
9795 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
9796 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
9797 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
9798 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
9799 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
9800 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
9801 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
9802 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
9803 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
9804 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009805 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009806
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009807show errors [<iid>]
9808 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
9809 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009810 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
9811 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
9812 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009813
9814 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
9815 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
9816 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
9817 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
9818 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
9819 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
9820 are reported too.
9821
9822 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
9823 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
9824 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
9825 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
9826 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
9827 code.
9828
9829 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
9830 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
9831 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
9832 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
9833 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
9834 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
9835 line.
9836
9837 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009838 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9839 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009840 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
9841 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
9842
9843 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
9844 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
9845 00038 Location: blah\r\n
9846 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
9847 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
9848 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
9849 00204+ minal\r\n
9850 00211 \r\n
9851
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009852 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009853 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
9854 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
9855 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
9856 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
9857 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
9858 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009859
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009860show info
9861 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
9862
9863show sess
9864 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009865 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
9866 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9867
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01009868show sess <id>
9869 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
9870 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
9871 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
9872 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
9873 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
9874 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009875
9876show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
9877 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
9878 possible to dump only selected items :
9879 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
9880 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
9881 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
9882 for example:
9883 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
9884 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
9885 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
9886
9887 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009888 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
9889 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009890 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
9891 Release_date: 2009/09/23
9892 Nbproc: 1
9893 Process_num: 1
9894 (...)
9895
9896 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
9897 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
9898 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
9899 (...)
9900 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
9901
9902 $
9903
9904 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
9905 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
9906 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
9907 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009908 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009909
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009910show table
9911 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
9912 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
9913 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
9914 entries currently in use.
9915
9916 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009917 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009918 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
9919 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009920
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009921show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009922 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
9923 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
9924 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009925 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
9926
9927 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
9928 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
9929 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
9930 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
9931 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
9932
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009933 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9934 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9935 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9936 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9937 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9938 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9939
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009940
9941 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +09009942 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
9943 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009944
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009945 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009946 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009947 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009948 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9949 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9950 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9951 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009952
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009953 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009954 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009955 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9956 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009957
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009958 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
9959 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009960 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009961 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9962 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009963
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009964 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
9965 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009966 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009967 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9968 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
9969
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009970 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
9971 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
9972 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
9973 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
9974 time goes, the average event rate drops.
9975
9976 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
9977 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
9978 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009979 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
9980 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009981 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
9982 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02009983
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +02009984shutdown frontend <frontend>
9985 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
9986 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
9987 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
9988 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
9989 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
9990 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
9991 once it is terminated.
9992
9993 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
9994 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9995
9996 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9997 level "admin".
9998
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +02009999shutdown session <id>
10000 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
10001 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10002 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
10003 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
10004 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
10005 flag in the logs.
10006
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020010007shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
10008 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
10009 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
10010 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
10011 'K' flag in the logs.
10012
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010013/*
10014 * Local variables:
10015 * fill-column: 79
10016 * End:
10017 */